blob: 59425aa8c2d0e38dbcd24c6bc65a70fb60c948de [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
545 - 51degrees-property-seperator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200548 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200550 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100551 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100552 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100553 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200554 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200555 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200556 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - noepoll
558 - nokqueue
559 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100560 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300561 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200562 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200563 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200564 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100565 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100566 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200567 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100568 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100569 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100570 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100571 - tune.lua.session-timeout
572 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100573 - tune.maxaccept
574 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200575 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200576 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200577 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100578 - tune.rcvbuf.client
579 - tune.rcvbuf.server
580 - tune.sndbuf.client
581 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100582 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100583 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200584 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100585 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200586 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200587 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100588 - tune.zlib.memlevel
589 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100590
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 * Debugging
592 - debug
593 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594
595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597------------------------------------
598
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200599ca-base <dir>
600 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200601 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
602 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604chroot <jail dir>
605 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
606 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
607 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
608 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
609 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
610 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100611
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100612cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
613 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
614 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
615 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100616 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
617 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
618 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
619 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
620 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
621 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
622 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
623 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
624 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
625 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100626
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200627crt-base <dir>
628 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
629 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
630 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632daemon
633 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
634 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
635 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
636
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200637deviceatlas-json-file <path>
638 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
639 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
640
641deviceatlas-log-level <value>
642 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
643 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
644
645deviceatlas-separator <char>
646 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
647 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
648
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900649external-check
650 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
651 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
652 See "option external-check".
653
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654gid <number>
655 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
656 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
657 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100658 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
659 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662group <group name>
663 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
664 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100665
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200666log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
668 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100669 configured with "log global".
670
671 <address> can be one of:
672
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100673 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
675 port).
676
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100677 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
678 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
679 port).
680
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100681 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
682 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
683 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
684 writeable).
685
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200686 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
687 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100688
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200689 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
690 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
691 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
692 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
693 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
694 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
695 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
696 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
697 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
698 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
699 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
700
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100701 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702
703 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
704 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
705 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
706
707 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200708 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
709 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
710 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
711 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
712 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
713 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200715 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100717log-send-hostname [<string>]
718 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
719 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
720 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
721 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
722 the logs.
723
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000724log-tag <string>
725 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
726 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
727 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100728 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000729
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100730lua-load <file>
731 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
732 used multiple times.
733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734nbproc <number>
735 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
736 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
737 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
738 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
739 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
740
741pidfile <pidfile>
742 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
743 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
744 starting the process. See also "daemon".
745
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100746stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200747 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
748 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
749 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
750 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
751 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
752 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100753 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200754 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
755 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200756
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100757ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
759 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300760 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100761 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
762 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
763 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
764 "bind" keyword for more information.
765
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100766ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
768 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
769 keyword to see available options.
770
771 Example:
772 global
773 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
774
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100775ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
777 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300778 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100779 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
780 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
781 information.
782
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100783ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
785 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
786 keyword to see available options.
787
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200788ssl-dh-param-file <file>
789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
790 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
791 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
792 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
793 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
794 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
795 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
796 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
797 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
798 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
799 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
800 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
801
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100802ssl-server-verify [none|required]
803 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
804 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
805 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
806
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200807stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
808 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
809 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
810 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
811 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200812
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200813 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
814 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
815 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200816
817stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
818 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
819 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100820 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200821
822stats maxconn <connections>
823 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
824 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
825
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826uid <number>
827 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
828 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
829 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
830 one. See also "gid" and "user".
831
832ulimit-n <number>
833 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
834 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
835 option.
836
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100837unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
838 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
839
840 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
841 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
842 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
843 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
844 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
845 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
846 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
847 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
848 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
849 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851user <user name>
852 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
853 See also "uid" and "group".
854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200855node <name>
856 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
857
858 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
859 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
860 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
861 traffic.
862
863description <text>
864 Add a text that describes the instance.
865
866 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
867 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
868 "<" and ">" characters.
869
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087051degrees-data-file <file path>
871 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
872 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
873
874 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
875 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
876
87751degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
878 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
879 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
880 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
881
882 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
883 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
884
88551degrees-property-seperator <char>
886 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
887 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
888
889 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
890 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200894-----------------------
895
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200896max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
897 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
898 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
899 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
900 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
901 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
902 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
903 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
904 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
905
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906maxconn <number>
907 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
908 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
909 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200910 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
911 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
912 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
913 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100914 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
915 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
916 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
917 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
918 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200920maxconnrate <number>
921 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
922 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
923 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
924 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
925 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
926 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
927 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
928 fairness.
929
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100930maxcomprate <number>
931 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300932 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100933 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
934 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
935 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
936 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
937 default value.
938
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100939maxcompcpuusage <number>
940 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
941 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
942 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
943 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
944 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
945 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
946 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
947 process down and from introducing high latencies.
948
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100949maxpipes <number>
950 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
951 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
952 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
953 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
954 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
955 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
956
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200957maxsessrate <number>
958 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
959 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
960 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
961 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
962 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
963 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
964 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
965 fairness.
966
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200967maxsslconn <number>
968 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
969 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
970 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
971 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
972 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
973 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
974 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100975 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
976 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
977 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
978 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
979 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
980 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
981 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200982
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200983maxsslrate <number>
984 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
985 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
986 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
987 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
988 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
989 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
990 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
991 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
992 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
993 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
994
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100995maxzlibmem <number>
996 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
997 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
998 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100999 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1000 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1001 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003noepoll
1004 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1005 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001006 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007
1008nokqueue
1009 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1010 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1011 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1012
1013nopoll
1014 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1015 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001016 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001017 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001019nosplice
1020 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1021 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1022 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001023 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001024 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1025 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1026 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1027 "option splice-response".
1028
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001029nogetaddrinfo
1030 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1031 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1032
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001033spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001034 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1035 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1036 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1037 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1038 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1039 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001040
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001041tune.buffers.limit <number>
1042 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1043 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1044 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1045 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1046 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1047 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1048 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1049 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1050 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1051 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1052 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1053 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1054 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1055 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1056 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1057
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001058tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1059 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1060 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1061 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1062 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1063
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001064tune.bufsize <number>
1065 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1066 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1067 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1068 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1069 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1070 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1071 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1072 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001073 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1074 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1075 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001077tune.chksize <number>
1078 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1079 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1080 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1081 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1082 checks whenever possible.
1083
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001084tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1085 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1086 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1087 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1088 this value. The default value is 1.
1089
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001090tune.http.cookielen <number>
1091 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1092 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1093 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1094 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1095 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1096 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1097 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1098 to change this value.
1099
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001100tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1101 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1102 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1103 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1104 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1105 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1106 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1107 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1108 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1109 limit too high.
1110
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001111tune.idletimer <timeout>
1112 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1113 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1114 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1115 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1116 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1117 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1118 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1119 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1120 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1121
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001122tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1123 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1124 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1125 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1126 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1127 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1128 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1129 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1130
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001131tune.lua.maxmem
1132 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1133 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1134 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1135 memory.
1136
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001137tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1138 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1139 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1140 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1141 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1142 4s.
1143
1144tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1145 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1146 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1147 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1148 check servers.
1149
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001150tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001151 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1152 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1153 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1154 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1155 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1156 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1157 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1158 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1159 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1160 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001161
1162tune.maxpollevents <number>
1163 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1164 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1165 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1166 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1167 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1168
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169tune.maxrewrite <number>
1170 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1171 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1172 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1173 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1174 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1175 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1176 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1177 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1178 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1179 bufsize.
1180
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001181tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1182 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1183 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1184 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1185 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1186 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1187 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1188 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1189 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1190 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1191 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1192 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1193 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1194 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1195 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1196 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1197 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1198 setting this parameter to 0.
1199
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001200tune.pipesize <number>
1201 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1202 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1203 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1204 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1205 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1206 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1207
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001208tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1209tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1210 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1211 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1212 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1213 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1214 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1215 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1216 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1217
1218tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1219tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1220 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1221 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1222 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1223 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1224 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1225 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1226 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1227 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1228 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1229 notifying haproxy again.
1230
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001231tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001232 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1233 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1234 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001235 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001236 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1237 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1238 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1239 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1240 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001241 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1242 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001243
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001244tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1245 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1246 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1247 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1248 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1249 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1250 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1251
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001252tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1253 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001254 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001255 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1256 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1257 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1258 being used for too long.
1259
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001260tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1261 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1262 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1263 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1264 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1265 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1266 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1267 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1268 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1269 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1270 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001271 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1272 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001273
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001274tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1275 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1276 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1277 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1278 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1279 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1280 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1281 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001282 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1283 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001284
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001285tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1286 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1287 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1288 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1289 1000 entries.
1290
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001291tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1292 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001293 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001294 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1295 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1296 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1297
1298tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1299 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1300 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1301 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1302 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013043.3. Debugging
1305--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306
1307debug
1308 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1309 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1310 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1311 system startup.
1312
1313quiet
1314 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1315 line argument "-q".
1316
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013183.4. Userlists
1319--------------
1320It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1321http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1322it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1323
1324userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001325 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001326 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1327
1328group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001329 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001330 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1331 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1332
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001333user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1334 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001335 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1336 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001337 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1338 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001339 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001340 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001341
1342
1343 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001344 userlist L1
1345 group G1 users tiger,scott
1346 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001347
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001348 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1349 user scott insecure-password elgato
1350 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001351
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001352 userlist L2
1353 group G1
1354 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001355
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001356 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1357 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1358 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001359
1360 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001361
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001362
13633.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001364----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001365It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1366haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1367pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1368identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1369or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1370Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1371known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1372the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1373process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1374during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1375tables.
1376
1377peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001378 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001379 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1380
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001381disabled
1382 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1383 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1384 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1385
1386enable
1387 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1388
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001389peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1390 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1391 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1392 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1393 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1394 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1395 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1396
1397 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1398 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1399
1400 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1401 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1402 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1403 across all peers.
1404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001405 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1406 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001407
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001408 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001409 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001410 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1411 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1412 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001413
1414 backend mybackend
1415 mode tcp
1416 balance roundrobin
1417 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1418 stick on src
1419
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001420 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1421 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001422
1423
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014243.6. Mailers
1425------------
1426It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1427If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1428in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1429
1430mailer <mailersect>
1431 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1432 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1433
1434mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1435 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1436
1437 Example:
1438 mailers mymailers
1439 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1440 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1441
1442 backend mybackend
1443 mode tcp
1444 balance roundrobin
1445
1446 email-alert mailers mymailers
1447 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1448 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1449
1450 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1451 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1452
1453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014544. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001457Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001458 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001459 - frontend <name>
1460 - backend <name>
1461 - listen <name>
1462
1463A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1464its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1465section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001467
1468A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1469connections.
1470
1471A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1472to forward incoming connections.
1473
1474A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1475parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1478'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1479case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1480
1481Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1482logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1483proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1484However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1485name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1486
1487Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1488and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001489bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1491modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1492arbitrary criteria.
1493
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001494In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1495a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1496the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1497
1498 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1499 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1500 between responses and new requests.
1501
1502 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1503 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1504 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1505 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1506
1507 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1508 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1509 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1510
1511 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1512 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1513 client-facing connection remains open.
1514
1515 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1516 after the end of the response.
1517
1518The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1519frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1520following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1521weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1522
1523 Backend mode
1524
1525 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1526 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1527 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1528 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1529 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1530 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1531 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1532 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1533 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1534 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1535 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001537
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015394.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1540--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001542The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1543limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1544they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1545limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001546marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001547option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001548and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1549with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1550specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001552
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001553 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1554------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1555acl - X X X
1556appsession - - X X
1557backlog X X X -
1558balance X - X X
1559bind - X X -
1560bind-process X X X X
1561block - X X X
1562capture cookie - X X -
1563capture request header - X X -
1564capture response header - X X -
1565clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001566compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001567contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1568cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001569declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001570default-server X - X X
1571default_backend X X X -
1572description - X X X
1573disabled X X X X
1574dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001575email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001576email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001577email-alert mailers X X X X
1578email-alert myhostname X X X X
1579email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001580enabled X X X X
1581errorfile X X X X
1582errorloc X X X X
1583errorloc302 X X X X
1584-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1585errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001586force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001587fullconn X - X X
1588grace X X X X
1589hash-type X - X X
1590http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001591http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001592http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001593http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001594http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001595http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001597ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001598log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001599log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001600log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001601max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001602maxconn X X X -
1603mode X X X X
1604monitor fail - X X -
1605monitor-net X X X -
1606monitor-uri X X X -
1607option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1608option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1609option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1610option allbackups (*) X - X X
1611option checkcache (*) X - X X
1612option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1613option contstats (*) X X X -
1614option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1615option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1616option forceclose (*) X X X X
1617-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1618option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001619option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001620option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001621option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001622option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001623option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001624option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001625option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001626option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1627option httpchk X - X X
1628option httpclose (*) X X X X
1629option httplog X X X X
1630option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001631option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001632option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001633option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001634option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1635option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1636option logasap (*) X X X -
1637option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001638option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001639option nolinger (*) X X X X
1640option originalto X X X X
1641option persist (*) X - X X
1642option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001643option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001644option smtpchk X - X X
1645option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1646option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1647option splice-request (*) X X X X
1648option splice-response (*) X X X X
1649option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1650option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1651-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001652option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001653option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1654option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1655option tcpka X X X X
1656option tcplog X X X X
1657option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001658external-check command X - X X
1659external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001660persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1661rate-limit sessions X X X -
1662redirect - X X X
1663redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1664redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1665reqadd - X X X
1666reqallow - X X X
1667reqdel - X X X
1668reqdeny - X X X
1669reqiallow - X X X
1670reqidel - X X X
1671reqideny - X X X
1672reqipass - X X X
1673reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674reqitarpit - X X X
1675reqpass - X X X
1676reqrep - X X X
1677-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001678reqtarpit - X X X
1679retries X - X X
1680rspadd - X X X
1681rspdel - X X X
1682rspdeny - X X X
1683rspidel - X X X
1684rspideny - X X X
1685rspirep - X X X
1686rsprep - X X X
1687server - - X X
1688source X - X X
1689srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001690stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001691stats auth X - X X
1692stats enable X - X X
1693stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001694stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001695stats realm X - X X
1696stats refresh X - X X
1697stats scope X - X X
1698stats show-desc X - X X
1699stats show-legends X - X X
1700stats show-node X - X X
1701stats uri X - X X
1702-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1703stick match - - X X
1704stick on - - X X
1705stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001706stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001707stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001708tcp-check connect - - X X
1709tcp-check expect - - X X
1710tcp-check send - - X X
1711tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001712tcp-request connection - X X -
1713tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001714tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001715tcp-response content - - X X
1716tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001717timeout check X - X X
1718timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001719timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001720timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1721timeout connect X - X X
1722timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1723timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1724timeout http-request X X X X
1725timeout queue X - X X
1726timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001727timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001728timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1729timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001730timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001731transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001732unique-id-format X X X -
1733unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001734use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001735use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001736------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1737 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017404.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1741---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742
1743This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1744
1745
1746acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1747 Declare or complete an access list.
1748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1749 no | yes | yes | yes
1750 Example:
1751 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1752 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1753 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001755 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756
1757
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001758appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1759 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1762 no | no | yes | yes
1763 Arguments :
1764 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1765 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1766
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001767 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768 checked in each cookie value.
1769
1770 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1771 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1772 milliseconds.
1773
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001774 request-learn
1775 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1776 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1777 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1778 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1779 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1780 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1781
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001782 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1783 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1784 data following this prefix.
1785
1786 Example :
1787 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1788
1789 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1790 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1791
1792 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1793 2 modes are currently supported :
1794 - path-parameters :
1795 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1796 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1797 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1798 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1799 - query-string :
1800 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1801 query string.
1802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1804 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1805 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1806 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001807 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1808 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1809 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1811 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1812
1813 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1814
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001815 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1816 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1817 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 Example :
1820 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1821
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001822 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1823 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
1825
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001826backlog <conns>
1827 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 yes | yes | yes | no
1830 Arguments :
1831 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1832 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001833 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001834
1835 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1836 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1837 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1838 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1839 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1840 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1841 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1842 backlog parameter.
1843
1844 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1845 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1846 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1847
1848 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1849
1850
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001852balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1855 yes | no | yes | yes
1856 Arguments :
1857 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1858 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1859 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1860 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1861
1862 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1863 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1864 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1865 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001866 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001867 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001868 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1869 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1870 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1871 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1872 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1873 it, so that you don't worry.
1874
1875 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1876 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1877 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1878 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1879 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1880 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1881 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1882 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001884 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1885 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1886 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1887 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1888 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1889 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1890 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1891 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1892
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001893 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001894 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001895 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1896 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001897 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001898 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1899 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1900 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1901 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1902 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001903 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1904 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1905 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1906 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1907 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1908 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1911 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1912 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1913 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1914 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1915 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1916 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1917 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001918 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001920 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1921 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1922 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001924 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1925 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1926 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1927 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1928 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1929 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1930 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1931 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1932 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1933 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1934 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1935 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001937 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001938 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1939 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1940 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1941 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1942 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1943 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1944 URIs start with a leading "/".
1945
1946 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1947 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1948 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1949 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001952 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1953
1954 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001955 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1956 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001957 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1958 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1959 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1960 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001961 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001962 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1963 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001964
1965 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1966 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1967 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1968 server will receive the request.
1969
1970 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1971 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1972 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1973 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1974 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001975 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1976 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1977 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001979 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1980 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1981 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1982 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1983 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001985 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001986 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1987 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1988 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1989
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001990 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1991 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1992 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1993
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001994 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001995 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001996 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1997 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1998 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1999 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2000 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2001 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002002 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002003 used instead.
2004
2005 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2006 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2007 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2008 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2009
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002010 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2011 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2012 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2013
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002014 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002017 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2018 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002019
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002020 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2021 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2022 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
2024 Examples :
2025 balance roundrobin
2026 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002027 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002028 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2029 balance hdr(host)
2030 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002031
2032 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2033 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002035 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002036 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2037 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2038 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2039 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2040
2041 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2042 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2043 defaults to 16 kB.
2044
2045 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2046 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2047
2048 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2049 Round Robin.
2050
2051 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2052 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2053 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2054 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2055
2056 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2057
2058 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002059 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002060 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2061 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2062 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002064 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2065 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066
2067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002068bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2069bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2072 no | yes | yes | no
2073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002074 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2075 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2076 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2077 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002078 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002079 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2080 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2081 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2082 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2083 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2084 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2085 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002086 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2087 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2088 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2089 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2090 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2091 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2092 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002093 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2094 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2095 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002096 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2097 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2098 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002099
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002100 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2101 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002102 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2103 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2104 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002105 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2106 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2107 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2108 the range.
2109
2110 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2111 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2112 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2113 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2114 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2115 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2116 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002117 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002118 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002120 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2121 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2122 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2123 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2124 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2125 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2126 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2127 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002129 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2130 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2131 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2132 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2135 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2136 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2137 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2138 in a frontend.
2139
2140 Example :
2141 listen http_proxy
2142 bind :80,:443
2143 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002144 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002146 listen http_https_proxy
2147 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002148 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002149
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002150 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2151 bind ipv6@:80
2152 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2153 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2154
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002155 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002156 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002157
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002158 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002159 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160
2161
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002162bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002163 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | yes | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2168 may be used to override a default value.
2169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002170 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002171 option may be combined with other numbers.
2172
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002173 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002174 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2175 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2176 missing from all processes.
2177
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002178 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002179 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002180 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2181 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2182 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2183 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002184
2185 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2186 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2187 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2188 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2189 and 'even' instances.
2190
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002191 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2192 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2193 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2194 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002195
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002196 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2197 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2198
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002199 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2200 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2201 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2202
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002203 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2204 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2205
2206 Example :
2207 listen app_ip1
2208 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002209 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002210
2211 listen app_ip2
2212 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002213 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002214
2215 listen management
2216 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002217 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002218
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002219 listen management
2220 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2221 bind-process 1-4
2222
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002223 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002224
2225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226block { if | unless } <condition>
2227 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2229 no | yes | yes | yes
2230
2231 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2232 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002233 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002234 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2236 "block" statements per instance.
2237
2238 Example:
2239 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2240 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2241 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2242 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002244 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246
2247capture cookie <name> len <length>
2248 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2250 no | yes | yes | no
2251 Arguments :
2252 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2253 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2254 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2255 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2256 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2257
2258 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2259 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2260 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2261 right if it exceeds <length>.
2262
2263 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2264 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2265 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2266 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2267
2268 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2269 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2270 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2271
2272 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2273 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2274 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002275 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2276 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2277 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278
2279 Example:
2280 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2281
2282 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002283 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
2285
2286capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002287 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2289 no | yes | yes | no
2290 Arguments :
2291 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002292 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2294 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2295 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2296
2297 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2298 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2299 it exceeds <length>.
2300
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002301 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2303 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002304 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2305 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2306 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2307 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002308 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002309 environments to find where the request came from.
2310
2311 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2312 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2313 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2314 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002316 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2317 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2318 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2319 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2320 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321
2322 Example:
2323 capture request header Host len 15
2324 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2325 capture request header Referrer len 15
2326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002327 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328 about logging.
2329
2330
2331capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002332 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2334 no | yes | yes | no
2335 Arguments :
2336 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002337 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2339 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2340 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2341
2342 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2343 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2344 it exceeds <length>.
2345
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002346 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002347 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2348 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2349 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002350 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2351 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2352 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2353 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002355 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2356 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2357 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2358 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2359 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360
2361 Example:
2362 capture response header Content-length len 9
2363 capture response header Location len 15
2364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002365 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366 about logging.
2367
2368
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002369clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002370 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2372 yes | yes | yes | no
2373 Arguments :
2374 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2375 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2376 as explained at the top of this document.
2377
2378 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2379 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2380 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2381 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2382 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2383 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2384 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2385 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002386 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2388 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2389
2390 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2391 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2392 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2393 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2394 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2395 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2396
2397 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2398 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2399
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002400 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2401 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002402
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002403compression algo <algorithm> ...
2404compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002405compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406 Enable HTTP compression.
2407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2408 yes | yes | yes | yes
2409 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002410 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2411 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2412 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2413
2414 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002415 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2416 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2417 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002418
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002419 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2420 support for zlib was built in.
2421
2422 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2423 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2424 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2425 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2426 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2427 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002428
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002429 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2430 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2431 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2432 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2433 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2434 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2435 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2436 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002437
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002438 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002439 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002440 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2441 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2442 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2443 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2444 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002445
2446 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2447 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2448 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2449 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2450 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002451 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2452 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2453 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2454 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2455 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002456 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2457 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002458
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002459 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002460 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2461 "Accept-Encoding" header
2462 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002463 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002464 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2465 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002466 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2467 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2468 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2469 "multipart"
2470 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2471 header
2472 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2473 and later
2474 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2475 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002476
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002477 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2478 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002479
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002480 Examples :
2481 compression algo gzip
2482 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002484contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 yes | no | yes | yes
2488 Arguments :
2489 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2490 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2491 as explained at the top of this document.
2492
2493 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002494 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002495 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002496 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2497 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2498 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2499 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2500
2501 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2502 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2503 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2504 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2505 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2506 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2507
2508 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2509 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2510 instead.
2511
2512 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2513 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2514
2515
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002516cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002517 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2518 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 yes | no | yes | yes
2522 Arguments :
2523 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2524 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2525 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2526 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2527 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2528 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2529 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2530 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2531 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2532
2533 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2534 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2535 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2536 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2537 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2538 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2539 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2540 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2541 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2542 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2543 "insert" and "prefix".
2544
2545 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002546 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002547
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002548 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002549 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2550 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2551 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2552 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2553 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2554 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2555 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2556 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2557 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2558 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559
2560 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2561 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2562 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2563 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2564 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2565 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2566 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2567 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2568 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2569 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002570 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2571 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2572 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002574 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2575 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2576 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002577 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2578 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2579 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2580 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002581 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2582 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2583 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002584
2585 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2586 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2587 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2588 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2589 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2590 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2591 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2592 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2593 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2594
2595 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2596 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2597 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2598 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2599 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2600 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2601 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2602 persistence cookie in the cache.
2603 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2604
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002605 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2606 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2607 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2608 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2609 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2610 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2611 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2612 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2613 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2614 they logout.
2615
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002616 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2617 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2618 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2619 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2620
2621 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2622 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2623 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2624 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2625 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2626 this attribute.
2627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002628 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002629 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002630 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2631 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2632 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2633 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2634 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2635 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002636
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002637 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2638 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2639 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2640 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2641 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2642 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2643 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2644 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2645 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2646 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2647 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2648 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2649 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2650 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2651 the site.
2652
2653 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2654 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2655 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2656 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2657 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2658 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2659 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2660 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2661 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2662 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2663 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2664 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2665 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2666 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2667 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2668 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2671 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2672 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2673 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675 Examples :
2676 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2677 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2678 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002679 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002681 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002682 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002684
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002685declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2686 Declares a capture slot.
2687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2688 no | yes | yes | no
2689 Arguments:
2690 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2691
2692 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2693 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2694 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2695 for use in the response.
2696
2697 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2698 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2699
2700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002701default-server [param*]
2702 Change default options for a server in a backend
2703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2704 yes | no | yes | yes
2705 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002706 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2707 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2708 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2709 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002710
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002711 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002712 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2713
2714 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717default_backend <backend>
2718 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2720 yes | yes | yes | no
2721 Arguments :
2722 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2723
2724 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2725 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2726 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2727 will catch all undetermined requests.
2728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002729 Example :
2730
2731 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2732 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2733 default_backend dynamic
2734
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002735 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002738description <string>
2739 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2741 no | yes | yes | yes
2742 Arguments : string
2743
2744 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2745 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2746 it describes.
2747 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2748
2749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750disabled
2751 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 yes | yes | yes | yes
2754 Arguments : none
2755
2756 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2757 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2758 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2759 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2760 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2761 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2762 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2763
2764 See also : "enabled"
2765
2766
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002767dispatch <address>:<port>
2768 Set a default server address
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002771 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002772
2773 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2774 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2775 during start-up.
2776
2777 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2778 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2779 possible with normal servers.
2780
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002781 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002782 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2783 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2784 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2785 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2786
2787 See also : "server"
2788
2789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790enabled
2791 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2793 yes | yes | yes | yes
2794 Arguments : none
2795
2796 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2797 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2798
2799 See also : "disabled"
2800
2801
2802errorfile <code> <file>
2803 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2805 yes | yes | yes | yes
2806 Arguments :
2807 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002808 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2809 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810
2811 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002812 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002814 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2815 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816
2817 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2818 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2819 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2820
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002821 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2824 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2825 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2826 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2827
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002828 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2829 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2830 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2831 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2832 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2833 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2836 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2837 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002838 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2840
2841 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2842
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002843 Example :
2844 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002845 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002846 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2847 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002849
2850errorloc <code> <url>
2851errorloc302 <code> <url>
2852 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2854 yes | yes | yes | yes
2855 Arguments :
2856 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002857 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002858
2859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2864
2865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2875 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2877 request.
2878
2879 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2880
2881
2882errorloc303 <code> <url>
2883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 yes | yes | yes | yes
2886 Arguments :
2887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2888 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2889
2890 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2891 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2892 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2893 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2894 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2895
2896 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2897 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2898 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2899
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002900 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2901
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002902 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2903 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2904 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2905 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002906 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002907
2908 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2909
2910
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002911email-alert from <emailaddr>
2912 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2913 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2915 yes | yes | yes | yes
2916
2917 Arguments :
2918
2919 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2920
2921 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2922 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2923
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002924 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2925 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2926
2927
2928email-alert level <level>
2929 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2930 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2932 yes | yes | yes | yes
2933
2934 Arguments :
2935
2936 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2937 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2938 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2939
2940 By default level is alert
2941
2942 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2943 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2944 for the proxy.
2945
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002946 Alerts are sent when :
2947
2948 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2949 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2950 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2951 is notice or lower
2952 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2953 and a health check status update occurs
2954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2956 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002957 section 3.6 about mailers.
2958
2959
2960email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2961 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2963 yes | yes | yes | yes
2964
2965 Arguments :
2966
2967 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2968
2969 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2970 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2971
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002972 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2973 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002974
2975
2976email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2977 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2978 mailers.
2979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 yes | yes | yes | yes
2981
2982 Arguments :
2983
2984 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2985
2986 By default the systems hostname is used.
2987
2988 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2989 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2990 for the proxy.
2991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2993 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002994
2995
2996email-alert to <emailaddr>
2997 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2998 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | yes
3001
3002 Arguments :
3003
3004 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3005
3006 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003010 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3011
3012
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003013force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3014 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3016 no | yes | yes | yes
3017
3018 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3019 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3020 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3021 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3022 marked down for maintenance operations.
3023
3024 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3025 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3026 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3027 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3028 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3029 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3030 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3031 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3032 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3033
3034 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3035 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3036 is used.
3037
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003038 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003039 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003040
3041
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003042fullconn <conns>
3043 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3045 yes | no | yes | yes
3046 Arguments :
3047 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3048 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3049
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003050 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003051 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003052 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003053 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3054 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3055 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3056 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3057 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003058 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003059
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003060 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3061 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003062 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3063 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3064 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003065
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003066 Example :
3067 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3068 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3069 # connections.
3070 backend dynamic
3071 fullconn 10000
3072 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3073 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3074
3075 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3076
3077
3078grace <time>
3079 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003081 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003082 Arguments :
3083 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3084 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3085 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3086
3087 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3088 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003089 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003090 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3091
3092 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3093 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3094 simplify it.
3095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003097hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003098 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | no | yes | yes
3101 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003102 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3103 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003104
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003105 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3106 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3107 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3108 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3109 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3110 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3111 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3112 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3113 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3114 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003115
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003116 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3117 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3118 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3119 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3120 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3121 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3122 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3123 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3124 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3125 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3126 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3127 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3128 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003129 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3130 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003131
3132 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3133
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003134 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003135 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3136 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3137 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003138 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3139 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3140 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003141
3142 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3143 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003144 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3145 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3146 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3147 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3148
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003149 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3150 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3151 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3152 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3153 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3154 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3155 parameter.
3156
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003157 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3158 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3159 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3160 used on strings.
3161
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003162 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3163
3164 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3165 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3166 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3167 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3168 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3169 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3170 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3171 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3172 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3173 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3174 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3175 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003176
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003177 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3178 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3179 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003180
3181 See also : "balance", "server"
3182
3183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184http-check disable-on-404
3185 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003187 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 Arguments : none
3189
3190 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3191 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3192 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3193 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3194 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3195 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3196 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3197 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003198 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3199 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3200 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3201
3202 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3203
3204
3205http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003206 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003208 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003209 Arguments :
3210 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3211 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003212 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003213 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3214 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3215 details on the supported keywords.
3216
3217 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3218 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3219 with the usual backslash ('\').
3220
3221 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3222 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3223 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3224 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3225 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3226
3227 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003228 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003229 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3230 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3231 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3232
3233 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003234 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003235 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3236 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3237 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3238 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3239
3240 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003241 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003242 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3243 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3244 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3245 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3246 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3247 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3248 trace).
3249
3250 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003251 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003252 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3253 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3254 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3255 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3256 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3257 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3258
3259 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3260 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3261 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3262 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3263 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3264 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3265 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3266 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3267
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003268 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3269 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3270 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3271
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003272 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3273 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3274
3275 Examples :
3276 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003277 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003278
3279 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003280 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003281
3282 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003283 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003284
3285 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003286 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003288 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003289
3290
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003291http-check send-state
3292 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 yes | no | yes | yes
3295 Arguments : none
3296
3297 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3298 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3299 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3300 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3301 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3302
3303 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3304 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3305 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3306 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3307 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003308 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3309 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3310 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3311
3312 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3313 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3314 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3315
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003316 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3317 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3318 checked in multiple backends.
3319
3320 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3321 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3322
3323 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3324 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3325 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3326 one fails.
3327
3328 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3329 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3330 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3331
3332 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3333 server's queue.
3334
3335 Example of a header received by the application server :
3336 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3337 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3338
3339 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3340
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003341http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003342 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003343 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003344 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003345 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3346 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003347 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3348 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003349 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3350 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3351 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003352 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003353 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3354 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003355 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003356 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003357 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3358
3359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3360 no | yes | yes | yes
3361
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003362 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3363 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3364 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3365 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3366 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003367
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003368 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3369 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3370 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3371
3372 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3373 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3374 are evaluated.
3375
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003376 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3377 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3378 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3379 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3380 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3381 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3382 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3383 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3384 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003385 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003386 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3387
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003388 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3389 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3390 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3391 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3392 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3393
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003394 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3395 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3396 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003397 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3398 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003399
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003400 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3401 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3402 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3403 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3404 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3405 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3406 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3407 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3408
3409 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3410 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3411 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003412 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3413 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003414
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003415 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3416 <name>.
3417
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003418 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3419 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3420 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3421 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3422 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3423 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3424 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3425 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3426
3427 Example:
3428
3429 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3430
3431 applied to:
3432
3433 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3434
3435 outputs:
3436
3437 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3438
3439 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3440
3441 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3442 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3443 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3444 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3445 header.
3446
3447 Example:
3448
3449 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3450
3451 applied to:
3452
3453 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3454
3455 outputs:
3456
3457 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3458
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003459 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3460 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3461 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3462 it.
3463
3464 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3465 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3466 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3467 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3468 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3469 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3470
3471 Example :
3472 # prepend the host name before the path
3473 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3474
3475 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3476 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3477 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3478 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3479 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3480 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3481 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3482 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3483
3484 Example :
3485 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3486 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3487
3488 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3489 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3490 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3491 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3492 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3493 "set-query".
3494
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003495 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3496 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3497 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3498 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3499 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3500 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3501 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3502 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3503
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003504 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3505 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3506 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3507 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3508 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3509 another equipment.
3510
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003511 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3512 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3513 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3514 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3515 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3516 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3517 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3518 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3519
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003520 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3521 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3522 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3523 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3524 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3525 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3526 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3527 admin privileges.
3528
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003529 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3530 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3531 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3532 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3533 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3534 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3535 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3536 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3537
3538 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3539 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3540 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3541 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3542 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3543 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3544
3545 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3546 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3547 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3548 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3549 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3550 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3551
3552 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3553 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3554 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3555 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3556 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3557 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3558 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3559 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3560 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3561
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003562 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003563 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3564 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3565 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3566 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3567 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3568 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3569 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3570 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3571 request header" for more information.
3572
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003573 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3574 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3575 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3576 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3577
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003578 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3579 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3580 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3581 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3582 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3583 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3584 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3585 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3586 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3587 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3588 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3589 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3590
3591 These actions take one or two arguments :
3592 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3593 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3594 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3595 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3596
3597 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3598 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3599 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3600 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3601
3602 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3603 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3604 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3605 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3606 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3607 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3608 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3609 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3610
3611 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3612 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3613 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3614 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3615 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3616
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003617 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3618 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3619 function is documented in the API documentation.
3620
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003621 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3622
3623 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3624 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3625 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3626 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003627
3628 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003629 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3630 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3631 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003632
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003633 http-request allow if nagios
3634 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3635 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3636 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003637
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003638 Example:
3639 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003640 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003641
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003642 Example:
3643 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3644 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3646 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3647 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3648 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3649 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3650 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3651 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3652
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003653 Example:
3654 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3655 acl add path /addacl
3656 acl del path /delacl
3657
3658 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3659
3660 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3661 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3662
3663 Example:
3664 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3665 acl setmap path /setmap
3666 acl delmap path /delmap
3667
3668 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3669
3670 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3671 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3672
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003673 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3674 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003675
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003676http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003677 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003678 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003679 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3680 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003681 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3682 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3683 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3684 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003685 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3686 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003687 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003688 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003689 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3690
3691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 no | yes | yes | yes
3693
3694 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3695 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3696 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3697 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3698 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3699 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3700
3701 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3702 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3703 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3704 current section.
3705
3706 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3707 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3708 rules are evaluated.
3709
3710 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3711 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3712 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3713 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3714 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3715 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3716 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3717
3718 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3719 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3720 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3721 external users.
3722
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003723 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3724 <name>.
3725
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003726 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3727 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3728 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3729 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3730 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3731 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3732 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3733 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3734
3735 Example:
3736
3737 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3738
3739 applied to:
3740
3741 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3742
3743 outputs:
3744
3745 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3746
3747 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3748
3749 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3750 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3751 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3752 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3753 header.
3754
3755 Example:
3756
3757 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3758
3759 applied to:
3760
3761 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3762
3763 outputs:
3764
3765 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3766
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003767 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3768 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3769 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3770 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3771 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3772 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3773 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3774 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3775
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003776 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3777 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3778 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3779 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3780 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3781 another equipment.
3782
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003783 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3784 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3785 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3786 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3787 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3788 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3789 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3790 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3791
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003792 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3793 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3794 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3795 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3796 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3797 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3798 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3799 admin privileges.
3800
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003801 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3802 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3803 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3804 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3805 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3806 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3807 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3808 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3809
3810 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3811 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3812 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3813 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3814 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3815 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3816
3817 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3818 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3819 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3820 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3821 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3822 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3823
3824 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3825 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3826 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3827 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3828 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3829 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3830 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3831 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3832 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3833
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003834 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3835 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3836 function is documented in the API documentation.
3837
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003838 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3839 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3840 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3841 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3842 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3843 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3844 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3845 response header" for more information.
3846
3847 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3848 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3849 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3850 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3851 keyword.
3852
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003853 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3854 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3855 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3856 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3857 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3858 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3859
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003860 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3861
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003862 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003863 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3864 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3865 rules.
3866
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003867 Example:
3868 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3869
3870 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3871
3872 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3873 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3874
3875 Example:
3876 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3877
3878 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3879
3880 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3881 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3882
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003883 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3884 ACL usage.
3885
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003886
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003887http-send-name-header [<header>]
3888 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3889
3890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | no | yes | yes
3892
3893 Arguments :
3894
3895 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3896
3897 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3898 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3899 is added with the header string proved.
3900
3901 See also : "server"
3902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003903id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003904 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3906 no | yes | yes | yes
3907 Arguments : none
3908
3909 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3910 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3911 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003912
3913
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003914ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3915 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 no | yes | yes | yes
3918
3919 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3920 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3921 and running).
3922
3923 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3924 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3925 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003926 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003927 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3928
3929 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3930 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3931
3932 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3933 "unless" condition is met.
3934
3935 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3936
3937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003939log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003940no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003941 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003944
3945 Prefix :
3946 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3947 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3948 prefix does not allow arguments.
3949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950 Arguments :
3951 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3952 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3953 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3954 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3955 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3956 parameter.
3957
3958 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3959 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3960
3961 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3962 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3963 standard syslog port).
3964
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003965 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3966 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3967 standard syslog port).
3968
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003969 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3970 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3971 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3972 appropriately writeable).
3973
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003974 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3975 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003976
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003977 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3978 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3979 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3980 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3981 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3982 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3983 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3984 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3985 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3986 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3987 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003989 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3990
3991 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3992 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3993 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3994
3995 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3996 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3997 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003998 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3999 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4000 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4001 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004003
4004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4005
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004006 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4007 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4008 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004009
4010 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4011 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4012 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4013 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4014
4015 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4016 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004017
4018 Example :
4019 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004020 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4021 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004022 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004023
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004025log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004026 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4028 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004029
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004030 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4031 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4032 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4033 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4034 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004035
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004036log-tag <string>
4037 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | yes | yes | yes
4040
4041 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4042 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4043 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4044 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4045 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4046 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4047 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4048 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4049 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004050
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004051max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4052 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 yes | no | yes | yes
4055
4056 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4057 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4058 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4059 servers.
4060
4061 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4062 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4063 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4064 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4065 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4066 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4067 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4068 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4069 picking a different server.
4070
4071 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4072 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4073 even if they have to be queued.
4074
4075 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4076 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4077
4078
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079maxconn <conns>
4080 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | yes | yes | no
4083 Arguments :
4084 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4085 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4086 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4087 closes.
4088
4089 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4090 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4091 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4092 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4093 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4094 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4095 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4096 properly tuned.
4097
4098 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4099 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4100 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4101
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004102 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004104 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4105
4106
4107mode { tcp|http|health }
4108 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | yes | yes | yes
4111 Arguments :
4112 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4113 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4114 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4115 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4116
4117 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4118 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4119 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4120 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4121 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4122
4123 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004124 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4125 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4126 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4127 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4128 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4129 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4130 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004131
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004132 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4133 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4134 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004136 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004137 defaults http_instances
4138 mode http
4139
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004140 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004141
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004143monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004144 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4146 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147 Arguments :
4148 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4149 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004150 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4152 backend and its backup.
4153
4154 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4155 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4156 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4157 servers in a list of backends.
4158
4159 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4160 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4161 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4162 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4163 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4164 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4165 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004166 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4167 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169 Example:
4170 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004171 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004172 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4173 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4174 monitor-uri /site_alive
4175 monitor fail if site_dead
4176
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004177 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004178
4179
4180monitor-net <source>
4181 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4183 yes | yes | yes | no
4184 Arguments :
4185 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4186 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4187 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4188 followed by a mask.
4189
4190 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4191 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004192 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004193 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4194
4195 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4196 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4197 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4198 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004199 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4200 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4201 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004202
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004203 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4204 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4205 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4206 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4207 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4208 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004209
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004210 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4211 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004212
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213 Example :
4214 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4215 frontend www
4216 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4217
4218 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4219
4220
4221monitor-uri <uri>
4222 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | no
4225 Arguments :
4226 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4227 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4228
4229 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4230 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4231 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4232 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4233 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4234 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4235 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4236 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4237
4238 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4239 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4240 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4241 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4242 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4243 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4244
4245 Example :
4246 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4247 frontend www
4248 mode http
4249 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4250
4251 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004253
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004254option abortonclose
4255no option abortonclose
4256 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4258 yes | no | yes | yes
4259 Arguments : none
4260
4261 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4262 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4263 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4264 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004265 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004266 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4267 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4268 encountered while delivering the response.
4269
4270 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4271 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4272 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4273 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4274 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4275 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004276 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004277 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004278 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004279 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4280 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4281 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4282
4283 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4284 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4285 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4286 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4287 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4288 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4289 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4290 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004291 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004292
4293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4295
4296 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4297
4298
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004299option accept-invalid-http-request
4300no option accept-invalid-http-request
4301 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4303 yes | yes | yes | no
4304 Arguments : none
4305
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004306 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004307 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4308 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4309 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4310 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4311 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4312 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4313 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004314 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4315 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4316 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4317 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4318 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004319 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004320 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4321 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4322 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004323
4324 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4325 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4326 been confirmed.
4327
4328 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4329 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004330 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4331 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004332 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4333
4334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4336
4337 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4338 stats socket.
4339
4340
4341option accept-invalid-http-response
4342no option accept-invalid-http-response
4343 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 yes | no | yes | yes
4346 Arguments : none
4347
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004348 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004349 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4350 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4351 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4352 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4353 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4354 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4355 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004356 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4357 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4358 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004359
4360 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4361 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4362 been confirmed.
4363
4364 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4365 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4366 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4367 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4368
4369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4371
4372 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4373 stats socket.
4374
4375
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004376option allbackups
4377no option allbackups
4378 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4380 yes | no | yes | yes
4381 Arguments : none
4382
4383 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4384 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4385 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4386 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4387 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4388 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4389 order between the backup servers anymore.
4390
4391 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4392 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4393
4394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4396
4397
4398option checkcache
4399no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004400 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | no | yes | yes
4403 Arguments : none
4404
4405 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4406 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004407 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004408 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4409 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004410 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004411
4412 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004413 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004414 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004415 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4416 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004417 to the client are :
4418 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004419 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004420 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004421 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4422 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4423 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4424 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4425 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4426 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4427 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4428 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4429 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4430 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4431 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4432
4433 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004434 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004435 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004436 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004437 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4438
4439 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4440 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004441 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004442 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4443
4444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4446
4447
4448option clitcpka
4449no option clitcpka
4450 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4452 yes | yes | yes | no
4453 Arguments : none
4454
4455 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4456 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4457 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4458 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4459
4460 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4461 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4462 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4463 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4464
4465 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4466 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4467 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4468 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4469 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4470
4471 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4472
4473 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4474 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4475 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4476
4477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4479
4480 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4481
4482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004483option contstats
4484 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4486 yes | yes | yes | no
4487 Arguments : none
4488
4489 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4490 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4491 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4492 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4493 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4494 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4495 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4496
4497
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004498option dontlog-normal
4499no option dontlog-normal
4500 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4502 yes | yes | yes | no
4503 Arguments : none
4504
4505 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4506 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4507 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4508 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4509 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4510 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4511 logged.
4512
4513 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4514 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4515 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004517 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004518 logging.
4519
4520
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004521option dontlognull
4522no option dontlognull
4523 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4525 yes | yes | yes | no
4526 Arguments : none
4527
4528 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4529 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4530 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4531 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4532 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4533 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004534 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4535 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4536 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004537
4538 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4539 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4540 would not be logged.
4541
4542 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4543 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4544
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004545 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4546 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004547
4548
4549option forceclose
4550no option forceclose
4551 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004553 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004554 Arguments : none
4555
4556 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4557 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4558 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4559 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4560 global session times in the logs.
4561
4562 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004563 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004564 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004565
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004566 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4567 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4568 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4569
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004570 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4571 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004572
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4575
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004576 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004577
4578
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004579option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004580 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | yes | yes | yes
4583 Arguments :
4584 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4585 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004586 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004587 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004588
4589 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4590 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4591 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4592 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4593 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4594 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4595 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004596 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4597 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4598 possible that the client has already brought one.
4599
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004600 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004601 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004602 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4603 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004604 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4605 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004606
4607 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4608 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4609 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4610 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4611 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4612 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4613 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4614
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004615 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4616 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4617 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4618 are under the control of the end-user.
4619
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004620 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004621 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4622 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004623 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4624 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4625 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004626
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004627 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004628 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4629 frontend www
4630 mode http
4631 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4632
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004633 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4634 backend www
4635 mode http
4636 option forwardfor header X-Client
4637
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004638 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004639 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004640
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004641
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004642option http-buffer-request
4643no option http-buffer-request
4644 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 yes | yes | yes | yes
4647 Arguments : none
4648
4649 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4650 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4651 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4652 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4653 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4654 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4655 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4656 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4657 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4658 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4659 default.
4660
4661 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4662
4663
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004664option http-ignore-probes
4665no option http-ignore-probes
4666 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 yes | yes | yes | no
4669 Arguments : none
4670
4671 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4672 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4673 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4674 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4675 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4676 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4677 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4678 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4679 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4680 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4681 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4682 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4683
4684 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4685 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4686 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4687 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4688 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4689 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4690 are often the only way to detect them.
4691
4692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4694
4695 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4696
4697
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004698option http-keep-alive
4699no option http-keep-alive
4700 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4702 yes | yes | yes | yes
4703 Arguments : none
4704
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004705 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4706 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4707 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4708 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4709 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4710 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4711 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4712
4713 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4714 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004715 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4716 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4717 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4718 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4719 situations where this option may be useful :
4720
4721 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4722 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4723
4724 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4725 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4726
4727 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4728 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4729 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4730 request.
4731
4732 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4733 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004734 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4735 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4736 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004737
4738 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4739 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4740
4741 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4742 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4743 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4744 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4745 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4746 not set.
4747
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004748 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4749 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004750 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004751 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004752
4753 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004754 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4755 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004756
4757
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004758option http-no-delay
4759no option http-no-delay
4760 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 yes | yes | yes | yes
4763 Arguments : none
4764
4765 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4766 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4767 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4768 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4769 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4770 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4771 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4772 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4773 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4774 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4775 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4776 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4777 affected.
4778
4779 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4780 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4781 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4782 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4783 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4784 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4785 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4786 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4787 latency environments.
4788
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004789 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4790
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004791
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004792option http-pretend-keepalive
4793no option http-pretend-keepalive
4794 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | yes | yes | yes
4797 Arguments : none
4798
4799 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4800 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4801 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4802 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4803 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4804 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4805 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4806 consider the response complete.
4807
4808 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4809 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4810 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4811 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4812 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4813 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4814
4815 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4816 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4817 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4818 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4819 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4820 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4821 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4822
4823 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4824 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004825 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004826 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4827 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004828
4829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4831
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004832 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4833 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004834
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004835
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004836option http-server-close
4837no option http-server-close
4838 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4840 yes | yes | yes | yes
4841 Arguments : none
4842
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004843 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4844 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4845 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4846 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4847 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4848 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4849 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4850 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4851 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4852 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4853 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4854 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4855 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4856 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4857 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4858 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004859
4860 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4861 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4862 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4863 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004864 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4865 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004866
4867 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4868 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004869 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4870 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004871 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4872 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004873
4874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4876
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004877 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004878 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4879 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004880
4881
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004882option http-tunnel
4883no option http-tunnel
4884 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments : none
4888
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004889 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4890 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4891 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4892 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4893 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4894 "option http-tunnel".
4895
4896 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004897 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004898 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4899 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4900 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4901 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4902 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4903 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4904 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004905
4906 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4907 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4908
4909 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4910 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4911 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4912
4913
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004914option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004915no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004916 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4918 yes | yes | yes | no
4919 Arguments : none
4920
4921 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4922 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4923 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4924 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4925 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4926 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4927 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4928
4929 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4930 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4931 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4932 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4933 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4934 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4935 request along its whole life.
4936
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004937 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4938 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4939 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4940 front of an existing proxy.
4941
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004942 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4943
4944 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4945 http-server-close".
4946
4947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004948option httpchk
4949option httpchk <uri>
4950option httpchk <method> <uri>
4951option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4952 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | no | yes | yes
4955 Arguments :
4956 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4957 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4958 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4959 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4960 ones.
4961
4962 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4963 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4964 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4965
4966 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4967 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4968 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4969 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4970 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4971
4972 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4973 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4974 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4975 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4976 the lack of any response.
4977
4978 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4979
4980 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4981 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4982 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4983
4984 Examples :
4985 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4986 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4987 backend https_relay
4988 mode tcp
4989 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4990 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4991
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004992 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4993 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4994 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004995
4996
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004997option httpclose
4998no option httpclose
4999 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | yes | yes | yes
5002 Arguments : none
5003
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005004 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5005 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5006 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5007 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005008 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005009 "option http-tunnel".
5010
5011 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5012 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5013 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5014 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5015 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5016 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5017 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5018 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005019
5020 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005021 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005022 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5023 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5024 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5025 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5026 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005027
5028 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5029 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005030 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5031 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005032 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5033 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005034
5035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5037
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005038 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5039 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005040
5041
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005042option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005043 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005046 Arguments :
5047 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5048 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5049 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5050 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5051 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005052
5053 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5054 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5055 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5056 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5057 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5058 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5059 ports.
5060
5061 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5062
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005063 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5064 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005066 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005068
5069option http_proxy
5070no option http_proxy
5071 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | yes | yes | yes
5074 Arguments : none
5075
5076 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5077 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5078 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5079 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5080 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5081
5082 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5083 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5084 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5085 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005086 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005087 be analyzed.
5088
5089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5091
5092 Example :
5093 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5094 backend direct_forward
5095 option httpclose
5096 option http_proxy
5097
5098 See also : "option httpclose"
5099
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005100
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005101option independent-streams
5102no option independent-streams
5103 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5105 yes | yes | yes | yes
5106 Arguments : none
5107
5108 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5109 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5110 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5111 receive data or not.
5112
5113 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5114 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5115 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5116 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5117 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5118 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5119 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5120 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5121 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5122 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5123 socket buffers.
5124
5125 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5126 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5127 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5128 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5129 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5130
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005131 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005132 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5133 deprecated.
5134
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005135 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005136
5137
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005138option ldap-check
5139 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | no | yes | yes
5142 Arguments : none
5143
5144 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5145 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5146 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5147 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5148
5149 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5150 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5151
5152 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5153 configure it.
5154
5155 Example :
5156 option ldap-check
5157
5158 See also : "option httpchk"
5159
5160
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005161option external-check
5162 Use external processes for server health checks
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
5165
5166 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5167 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5168 command".
5169
5170 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5171
5172 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5173
5174
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005175option log-health-checks
5176no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005177 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | no | yes | yes
5180 Arguments : none
5181
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005182 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5183 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5184 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005185
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005186 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5187 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5188 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5189 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5190 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5191
5192 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5193 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005194
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005195 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5196 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5197 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005198
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005199
5200option log-separate-errors
5201no option log-separate-errors
5202 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 yes | yes | yes | no
5205 Arguments : none
5206
5207 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5208 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5209 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5210 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5211 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5212 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5213 provides very important information.
5214
5215 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5216 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5217 error logs.
5218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005219 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005220 logging.
5221
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005222
5223option logasap
5224no option logasap
5225 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5227 yes | yes | yes | no
5228 Arguments : none
5229
5230 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5231 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5232 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5233 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5234 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5235 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5236 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005237 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005238 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5239 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5240
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005241 Examples :
5242 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5243 mode http
5244 option httplog
5245 option logasap
5246 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5247
5248 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5249 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5250 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5251 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005253 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005254 logging.
5255
5256
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005257option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005258 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005261 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005262 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5263 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005264 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005265
5266 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5267 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5268 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5269 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5270 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5271 in the MySQL table, like this :
5272
5273 USE mysql;
5274 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5275 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5276
5277 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5278 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5279 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5280 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5281 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5282 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5283 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5284 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5285 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5286
5287 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5288 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005289
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005290 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005291
5292 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5293 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5294 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5295 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5296 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5297 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5298
5299 See also: "option httpchk"
5300
5301
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005302option nolinger
5303no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005304 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005307 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005308
5309 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5310 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5311 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5312 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5313 connections.
5314
5315 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5316 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5317 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5318 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5319 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5320 this too.
5321
5322 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5323 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5324 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5325
5326 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5327 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5328 for servers.
5329
5330 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5331 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5332
5333
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005334option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5335 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | yes | yes | yes
5338 Arguments :
5339 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5340 matching <network>
5341 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5342 header name.
5343
5344 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5345 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5346 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5347 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5348 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5349 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5350 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5351 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5352 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5353 possible that the client has already brought one.
5354
5355 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5356 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5357 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5358 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5359 header and requires different one.
5360
5361 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5362 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5363 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5364 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5365 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5366 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5367 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5368
5369 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5370 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5371 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5372 both are defined.
5373
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005374 Examples :
5375 # Original Destination address
5376 frontend www
5377 mode http
5378 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5379
5380 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5381 backend www
5382 mode http
5383 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5384
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005385 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5386 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005387
5388
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005389option persist
5390no option persist
5391 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005394 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005395
5396 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5397 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5398 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5399 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5400 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5401 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5402 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5403 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5404 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5405 redirected to another valid server.
5406
5407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5409
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005410 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005411
5412
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005413option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5414 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | no | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5419 PostgreSQL server.
5420
5421 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5422 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5423 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5424 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5425
5426 See also: "option httpchk"
5427
5428
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005429option prefer-last-server
5430no option prefer-last-server
5431 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5433 yes | no | yes | yes
5434 Arguments : none
5435
5436 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5437 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5438 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5439 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5440 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5441 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5442 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5443 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5444 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005445 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5446 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5447 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5448 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5449 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5450 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5451 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005452
5453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5455
5456 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5457
5458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005459option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005460option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005461no option redispatch
5462 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005465 Arguments :
5466 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5467 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5468 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5469 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5470 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5471 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5472 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5473 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5474 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005476
5477 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5478 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5479 be able to access the service anymore.
5480
5481 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5482 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5483
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005484 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005485 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5486 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005488 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5489 "redisp" keywords.
5490
5491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5493
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005494 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005495
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005496
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005497option redis-check
5498 Use redis health checks for server testing
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 yes | no | yes | yes
5501 Arguments : none
5502
5503 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5504 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5505 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5506 find the "+PONG" response message.
5507
5508 Example :
5509 option redis-check
5510
5511 See also : "option httpchk"
5512
5513
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005514option smtpchk
5515option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5516 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005519 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005520 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5521 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5522 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5523
5524 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5525 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5526 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5527
5528 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5529 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5530 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5531 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5532 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5533 dead server.
5534
5535 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5536 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5537 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5538 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5539
5540 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5541 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5542 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5543 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5544 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5545
5546 Example :
5547 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5548
5549 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005552option socket-stats
5553no option socket-stats
5554
5555 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 yes | yes | yes | no
5558
5559 Arguments : none
5560
5561
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005562option splice-auto
5563no option splice-auto
5564 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | yes | yes | yes
5567 Arguments : none
5568
5569 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5570 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5571 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5572 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005573 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005574 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5575 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5576 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5577 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5578
5579 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5580 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5581 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5582 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5583 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5584 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5585 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5586 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5587 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5588 keyword.
5589
5590 Example :
5591 option splice-auto
5592
5593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5595
5596 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5597 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5598
5599
5600option splice-request
5601no option splice-request
5602 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | yes | yes | yes
5605 Arguments : none
5606
5607 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005608 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005609 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5610 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5611 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5612 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5613
5614 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5615
5616 Example :
5617 option splice-request
5618
5619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5621
5622 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5623 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5624
5625
5626option splice-response
5627no option splice-response
5628 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | yes | yes | yes
5631 Arguments : none
5632
5633 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005634 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005635 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5636 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5637 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5638 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5639
5640 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5641
5642 Example :
5643 option splice-response
5644
5645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5647
5648 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5649 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5650
5651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005652option srvtcpka
5653no option srvtcpka
5654 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
5657 Arguments : none
5658
5659 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5660 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5661 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5662 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5663
5664 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5665 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5666 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5667 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5668
5669 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5670 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5671 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5672 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5673 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5674
5675 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5676
5677 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5678 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5679 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5680
5681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5683
5684 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5685
5686
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005687option ssl-hello-chk
5688 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | no | yes | yes
5691 Arguments : none
5692
5693 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5694 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5695 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5696 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5697 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5698 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5699 hello message.
5700
5701 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5702 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5703 messages, which is appreciable.
5704
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005705 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5706 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5707 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005708
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005709 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5710
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005711
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005712option tcp-check
5713 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5715 yes | no | yes | yes
5716
5717 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5718 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5719
5720 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5721 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5722 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5723
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005724 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005725 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5726 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5727 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5728 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5729 only.
5730
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005731 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005732 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5733 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5734 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5735 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5736
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005737 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005738 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5739 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005740 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005741 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5742 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5743 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5744 the respective protocols.
5745 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5746 analysed.
5747
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005748 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5749 script.
5750
5751 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5752 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5753 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5754 The "comment" is of course optional.
5755
5756
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005757 Examples :
5758 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5759 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005760 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005761
5762 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5763 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005764 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005765
5766 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5767 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005768 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005769 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005770 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005771 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005772 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5773 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005774 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5775 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005776 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005777 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5778 tcp-check expect string +OK
5779
5780 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5781 (send many headers before analyzing)
5782 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005783 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005784 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5785 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5786 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5787 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005788 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005789
5790
5791 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5792
5793
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005794option tcp-smart-accept
5795no option tcp-smart-accept
5796 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | yes | yes | no
5799 Arguments : none
5800
5801 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5802 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5803 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5804 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5805 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5806 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5807
5808 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5809 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5810 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5811 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5812
5813 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5814 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5815 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5816 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5817
5818 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5819 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5820 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5821
5822 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5823 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5824 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5825
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005826 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5827
5828
5829option tcp-smart-connect
5830no option tcp-smart-connect
5831 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 yes | no | yes | yes
5834 Arguments : none
5835
5836 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5837 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5838 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5839 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5840 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5841
5842 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5843 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5844 complex.
5845
5846 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5847 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5848 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5849
5850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5852
5853 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5854
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005856option tcpka
5857 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 yes | yes | yes | yes
5860 Arguments : none
5861
5862 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5863 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5864 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5865 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5866
5867 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5868 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5869 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5870 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5871
5872 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5873 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5874 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5875 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5876 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5877
5878 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5879
5880 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5881 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5882 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5883 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5884 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5885 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5886 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5887 backends.
5888
5889 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5890
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005891
5892option tcplog
5893 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | yes | yes | yes
5896 Arguments : none
5897
5898 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5899 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5900 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5901 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5902 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5903 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5904 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5905 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5906
5907 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005909 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005910
5911
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005912option transparent
5913no option transparent
5914 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005916 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005917 Arguments : none
5918
5919 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5920 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5921 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5922 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5923 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5924 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5925 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5926 appropriate server.
5927
5928 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5929 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5930
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005931 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005932 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005934
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005935external-check command <command>
5936 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | no | yes | yes
5939
5940 Arguments :
5941 <command> is the external command to run
5942
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005943 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5944
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005945 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005946
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005947 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5948 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5949 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5950 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5951 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5952 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005953
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005954 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5955
5956 Environment variables :
5957 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5958 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5959
5960 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5961
5962 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5963
5964 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5965 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5966 for a UNIX socket).
5967
5968 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5969
5970 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5971
5972 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5973
5974 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5975
5976 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5977
5978 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5979 socket).
5980
5981 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5982 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5983
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005984 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5985 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5986 failed.
5987
5988 Example :
5989 external-check command /bin/true
5990
5991 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5992
5993
5994external-check path <path>
5995 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | no | yes | yes
5998
5999 Arguments :
6000 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6001
6002 The default path is "".
6003
6004 Example :
6005 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6006
6007 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6008 "external-check command"
6009
6010
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006011persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006012persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006013 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | no | yes | yes
6016 Arguments :
6017 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006018 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6019 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006020
6021 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6022 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6023 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6024 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6025 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6026 forwarded to this server.
6027
6028 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6029 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6030 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006031 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006032 a single "listen" section.
6033
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006034 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6035 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6036 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6037
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006038 Example :
6039 listen tse-farm
6040 bind :3389
6041 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6042 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6043 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6044 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6045 persist rdp-cookie
6046 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006047 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006048 balance rdp-cookie
6049 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6050 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6051
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006052 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6053 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006054
6055
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006056rate-limit sessions <rate>
6057 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | yes | yes | no
6060 Arguments :
6061 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6062 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6063
6064 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6065 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6066 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6067 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6068 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6069 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6070
6071 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6072 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6073 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6074 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6075
6076 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6077 listen smtp
6078 mode tcp
6079 bind :25
6080 rate-limit sessions 10
6081 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6082
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006083 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6084 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6085 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006086
6087 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6088
6089
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006090redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6091redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6092redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006093 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 no | yes | yes | yes
6096
6097 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006098 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006099
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006101 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006102 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6103 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6104 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006105
6106 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6107 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6108 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6109 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6110 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006111 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6112 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6113 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6114 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006115
6116 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6117 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6118 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6119 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6120 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6121 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006122 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006123 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006124 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6125 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6126 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006127
6128 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006129 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6130 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6131 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6132 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6133 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6134 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6135 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6136 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006137
6138 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6139 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6140
6141 - "drop-query"
6142 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6143 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6144 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6145 with a location-type redirect.
6146
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006147 - "append-slash"
6148 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6149 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6150 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6151 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6152
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006153 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6154 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6155 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6156 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6157 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6158 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6159 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6160
6161 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6162 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6163 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6164 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6165 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6166 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6167 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006168
6169 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6170 acl clear dst_port 80
6171 acl secure dst_port 8080
6172 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006173 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006174 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006175 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6176
6177 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006178 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6179 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6180 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006181 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006182
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006183 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6184 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6185 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6186
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006187 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006188 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006189
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006190 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6191 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6192 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006194 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006195
6196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006197redisp (deprecated)
6198redispatch (deprecated)
6199 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6200 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6201 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006202 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006203
6204 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6205 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6206 be able to access the service anymore.
6207
6208 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6209 redistribute them to a working server.
6210
6211 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6212 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6213 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006215 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6216 "option redispatch" instead.
6217
6218 See also : "option redispatch"
6219
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006220
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006221reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006222 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 no | yes | yes | yes
6225 Arguments :
6226 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6227 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006228 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006229
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006230 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6231 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6232
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006233 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6234 the last header of an HTTP request.
6235
6236 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6237 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6238 responses.
6239
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006240 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6241 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6242 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6243
6244 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6245 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006246
6247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006248reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6249reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006250 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 no | yes | yes | yes
6253 Arguments :
6254 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6255 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6256 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6257 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6258 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6259 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6260 ignores case.
6261
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006262 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6263 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6264
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006265 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6266 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6267 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6268 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006269 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006270
6271 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6272 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6273
6274 Example :
6275 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6276 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6277 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6278
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006279 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6280 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006281
6282
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006283reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6284reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006285 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6287 no | yes | yes | yes
6288 Arguments :
6289 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6290 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6291 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6292 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6293 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6294 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006296 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6297 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6298
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006299 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6300 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6301 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6302 next servers.
6303
6304 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6305 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6306 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6307
6308 Example :
6309 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6310 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6311 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6312
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006313 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6314 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006315
6316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006317reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6318reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006319 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 no | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6324 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6325 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6326 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6327 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6328 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6329 case.
6330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006331 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6332 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6333
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006334 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6335 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6336 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6337 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006338 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006339
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006340 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006341 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006342 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006343
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006344 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6345 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6346
6347 Example :
6348 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6349 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6350 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006352 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6353 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006354
6355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006356reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6357reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006358 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 no | yes | yes | yes
6361 Arguments :
6362 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6363 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6364 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6365 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6366 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6367 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6368 case.
6369
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006370 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6371 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6372
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006373 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6374 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6375 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6376 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6377
6378 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6379 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6380
6381 Example :
6382 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6383 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6384 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6385 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6386
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006387 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6388 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006389
6390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006391reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6392reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006393 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 no | yes | yes | yes
6396 Arguments :
6397 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6398 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6399 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6400 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6401 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6402 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6403
6404 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6405 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6406 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6407 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006408 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006413 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6414 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6415 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6416
6417 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6418 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6419 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6420 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6421 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6422
6423 Example :
6424 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006425 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006426 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6427 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6428
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006429 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6430 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006431
6432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006433reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6434reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006435 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6437 no | yes | yes | yes
6438 Arguments :
6439 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6440 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6441 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6442 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6443 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6444 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6445 ignores case.
6446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006447 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6448 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6449
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006450 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6451 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006452 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6453 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6454 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006455 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6456 not set.
6457
6458 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6459 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6460 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6461 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6462 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6463
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006464 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006465 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6466 # block all others.
6467 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6468 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006470 # block bad guys
6471 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6472 reqitarpit . if badguys
6473
6474 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6475 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006476
6477
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006478retries <value>
6479 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6481 yes | no | yes | yes
6482 Arguments :
6483 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6484 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6485 default value is 3.
6486
6487 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6488 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6489 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6490
6491 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006492 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6493 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006494
6495 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6496 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6497
6498 See also : "option redispatch"
6499
6500
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006501rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006502 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6504 no | yes | yes | yes
6505 Arguments :
6506 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6507 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006508 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006509
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006510 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6511 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6512
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006513 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6514 the last header of an HTTP response.
6515
6516 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6517 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6518 responses.
6519
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006520 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6521 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006522
6523
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006524rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6525rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006526 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 no | yes | yes | yes
6529 Arguments :
6530 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6531 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6532 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6533 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6534 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6535 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6536 ignores case.
6537
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006538 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6539 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6540
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006541 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6542 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006543 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006544 client.
6545
6546 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6547 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6548 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6549
6550 Example :
6551 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006552 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006553
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006554 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6555 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006556
6557
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006558rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6559rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006560 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 no | yes | yes | yes
6563 Arguments :
6564 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6565 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6566 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6567 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6568 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6569 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6570 ignores case.
6571
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006572 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6573 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6574
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006575 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6576 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6577 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6578 case-sensitive.
6579
6580 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006581 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6582 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6583 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006584
6585 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6586 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6587
6588 Example :
6589 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6590 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6591
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006592 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6593 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006594
6595
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006596rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6597rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006598 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6600 no | yes | yes | yes
6601 Arguments :
6602 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6603 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6604 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6605 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6606 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6607 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6608 ignores case.
6609
6610 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6611 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6612 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6613 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006614 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006615
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006616 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6617 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6618
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006619 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6620 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6621 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6622
6623 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6624 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6625 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6626 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6627 are not case-sensitive.
6628
6629 Example :
6630 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6631 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6632
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006633 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6634 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006635
6636
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006637server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006638 Declare a server in a backend
6639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6640 no | no | yes | yes
6641 Arguments :
6642 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006643 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006644 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006645
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006646 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6647 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6648 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6649 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006650 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6651 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6652 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6653 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6654 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006655 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6656 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6657 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6658 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6659 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6660 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6661 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006662 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006663 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6664 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6665 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006667 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006668 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6669 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6670 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6671 adding this value to the client's port.
6672
6673 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6674 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006675 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006676
6677 Examples :
6678 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6679 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006680 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006681 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6682 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6683 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006684
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006685 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6686 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006687
6688
6689source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006690source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006691source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006692 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | no | yes | yes
6695 Arguments :
6696 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6697 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006699 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006700 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6701 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6702 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6703 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6704 supported prefixes are :
6705 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6706 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6707 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006708 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006709 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6710 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006711
6712 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6713 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006714 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6715 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6716 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006717
6718 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6719 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6720 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6721 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6722 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6723 <addr>.
6724
6725 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6726 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6727 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6728 port.
6729
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006730 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6731 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6732 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6733 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006734 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006735 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6736 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6737 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6738 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6739 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6740 HTTP header.
6741
6742 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6743 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006744 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006745 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6746 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6747 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6748 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6749 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6750 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6751 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6752
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006753 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6754 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6755 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6756 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6757 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6758 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6759
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006760 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6761 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6762 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6763 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6764
6765 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6766 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6767 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6768 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6769 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6770 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6771
6772 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6773 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6774 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6775 there are two methods :
6776
6777 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6778 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6779 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6780 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6781 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6782 of the client ranges may be used.
6783
6784 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6785 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6786 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6787 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6788 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6789 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6790 same session.
6791
6792 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6793 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6794 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6795 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6796 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6797 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6798
6799 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6800 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6801 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006802 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006803
6804 Examples :
6805 backend private
6806 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6807 source 192.168.1.200
6808
6809 backend transparent_ssl1
6810 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6811 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6812
6813 backend transparent_ssl2
6814 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6815 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6816 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6817
6818 backend transparent_ssl3
6819 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6820 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6821 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6822
6823 backend transparent_smtp
6824 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6825 # with Tproxy version 4.
6826 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6827
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006828 backend transparent_http
6829 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6830 # proxy.
6831 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006833 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006834 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006836
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006837srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6838 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | no | yes | yes
6841 Arguments :
6842 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6844 as explained at the top of this document.
6845
6846 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6847 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6848 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6849 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6850 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6851 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6852 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6853
6854 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6855 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6856 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6857 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6858 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006859 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006860 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006861 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006862
6863 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6864 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6865 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6866 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6867 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6868 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6869
6870 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6871 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6872
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006873 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6874 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006875
6876
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006877stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6878 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006880 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006881
6882 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6883 matched.
6884
6885 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6886 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6887
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006888 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6889 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6890 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6891
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006892 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6893 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6894 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6895 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006896
6897 Example :
6898 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6899 backend stats_localhost
6900 stats enable
6901 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6902
6903 Example :
6904 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6905 backend stats_auth
6906 stats enable
6907 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6908 stats admin if TRUE
6909
6910 Example :
6911 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6912 userlist stats-auth
6913 group admin users admin
6914 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6915 group readonly users haproxy
6916 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6917
6918 backend stats_auth
6919 stats enable
6920 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6921 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6922 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6923 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6924
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006925 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6926 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6927 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006928
6929
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006930stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6931 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006933 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006934 Arguments :
6935 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6936
6937 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6938
6939 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6940 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6941 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6942 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6943 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6944 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6945
6946 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6947 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6948 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006949 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006950
6951 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6952 report using "stats scope".
6953
6954 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6955 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6956 unobvious parameters.
6957
6958 Example :
6959 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6960 backend public_www
6961 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6962 stats enable
6963 stats hide-version
6964 stats scope .
6965 stats uri /admin?stats
6966 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6967 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6968 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6969
6970 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6971 backend private_monitoring
6972 stats enable
6973 stats uri /admin?stats
6974 stats refresh 5s
6975
6976 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6977
6978
6979stats enable
6980 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006982 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006983 Arguments : none
6984
6985 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6986 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6987 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6988 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6989 - stats auth : no authentication
6990 - stats scope : no restriction
6991
6992 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6993 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6994 unobvious parameters.
6995
6996 Example :
6997 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6998 backend public_www
6999 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7000 stats enable
7001 stats hide-version
7002 stats scope .
7003 stats uri /admin?stats
7004 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7005 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7006 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7007
7008 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7009 backend private_monitoring
7010 stats enable
7011 stats uri /admin?stats
7012 stats refresh 5s
7013
7014 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7015
7016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007017stats hide-version
7018 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007020 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007021 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007022
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007023 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7024 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7025 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7026 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7027 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7028 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007030 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7031 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7032 unobvious parameters.
7033
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007034 Example :
7035 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7036 backend public_www
7037 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007038 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007039 stats hide-version
7040 stats scope .
7041 stats uri /admin?stats
7042 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7043 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7044 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007045
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007046 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7047 backend private_monitoring
7048 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007049 stats uri /admin?stats
7050 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007052 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007053
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007054
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007055stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7057 Access control for statistics
7058
7059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | no | yes | yes
7061
7062 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7063 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7064 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7065 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7066 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7067 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7068
7069 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7070 instance.
7071
7072 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7073 about ACL usage.
7074
7075
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007076stats realm <realm>
7077 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007080 Arguments :
7081 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7082 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7083 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7084
7085 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7086 using a backslash ('\').
7087
7088 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7089 only related to authentication.
7090
7091 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7092 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7093 unobvious parameters.
7094
7095 Example :
7096 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7097 backend public_www
7098 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7099 stats enable
7100 stats hide-version
7101 stats scope .
7102 stats uri /admin?stats
7103 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7104 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7105 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7106
7107 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7108 backend private_monitoring
7109 stats enable
7110 stats uri /admin?stats
7111 stats refresh 5s
7112
7113 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7114
7115
7116stats refresh <delay>
7117 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007119 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007120 Arguments :
7121 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7122 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7123 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7124 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7125 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7126 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7127
7128 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7129 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7130 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7131 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7132
7133 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7134 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7135 unobvious parameters.
7136
7137 Example :
7138 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7139 backend public_www
7140 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7141 stats enable
7142 stats hide-version
7143 stats scope .
7144 stats uri /admin?stats
7145 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7146 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7147 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7148
7149 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7150 backend private_monitoring
7151 stats enable
7152 stats uri /admin?stats
7153 stats refresh 5s
7154
7155 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7156
7157
7158stats scope { <name> | "." }
7159 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007161 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007162 Arguments :
7163 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7164 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7165 section in which the statement appears.
7166
7167 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7168 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7169 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7170 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7171 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7172 exists.
7173
7174 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7175 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7176 unobvious parameters.
7177
7178 Example :
7179 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7180 backend public_www
7181 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7182 stats enable
7183 stats hide-version
7184 stats scope .
7185 stats uri /admin?stats
7186 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7187 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7188 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7189
7190 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7191 backend private_monitoring
7192 stats enable
7193 stats uri /admin?stats
7194 stats refresh 5s
7195
7196 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7197
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007198
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007199stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007200 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007202 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007203
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007204 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007205 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7206
7207 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7208 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7209
7210 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7211 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007212 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007213
7214 Example :
7215 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7216 backend private_monitoring
7217 stats enable
7218 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7219 stats uri /admin?stats
7220 stats refresh 5s
7221
7222 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7223 global section.
7224
7225
7226stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007227 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7229 yes | yes | yes | yes
7230 Arguments : none
7231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007232 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007233 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7234 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7235 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7236 - IP (socket, server)
7237 - cookie (backend, server)
7238
7239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007241 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007242
7243 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7244
7245
7246stats show-node [ <name> ]
7247 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007249 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007250 Arguments:
7251 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7252 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7253
7254 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7255 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007256 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007257
7258 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7259 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7260 unobvious parameters.
7261
7262 Example:
7263 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7264 backend private_monitoring
7265 stats enable
7266 stats show-node Europe-1
7267 stats uri /admin?stats
7268 stats refresh 5s
7269
7270 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7271 section.
7272
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007273
7274stats uri <prefix>
7275 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007277 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007278 Arguments :
7279 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7280 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7281 query string.
7282
7283 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7284 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7285 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7286 possible to reach it in the application.
7287
7288 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007289 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007290 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7291 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7292 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7293 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7294
7295 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7296 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7297 an address or a port to statistics only.
7298
7299 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7300 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7301 unobvious parameters.
7302
7303 Example :
7304 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7305 backend public_www
7306 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7307 stats enable
7308 stats hide-version
7309 stats scope .
7310 stats uri /admin?stats
7311 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7312 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7313 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7314
7315 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7316 backend private_monitoring
7317 stats enable
7318 stats uri /admin?stats
7319 stats refresh 5s
7320
7321 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7322
7323
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007324stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7325 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007327 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007328
7329 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007330 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007331 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7332 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7333 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7334
7335 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7336 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7337 the "stick-table" statement.
7338
7339 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7340 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7341 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7342 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7343 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7344
7345 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7346 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7347 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7348 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7349 transformation rules.
7350
7351 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7352 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7353 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7354 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7355 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7356 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7357 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7358
7359 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7360 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7361 ACL based conditions.
7362
7363 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7364 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7365 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7366 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7367
7368 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7369 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7370 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7371 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7372
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007373 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7374 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7375 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7376
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007377 Example :
7378 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7379 # last 30 minutes
7380 backend pop
7381 mode tcp
7382 balance roundrobin
7383 stick store-request src
7384 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7385 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7386 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7387
7388 backend smtp
7389 mode tcp
7390 balance roundrobin
7391 stick match src table pop
7392 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7393 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7394
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007395 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007396 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007397
7398
7399stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7400 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 no | no | yes | yes
7403
7404 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7405 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7406 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7407 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7408
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007409 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7410 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7411 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7412
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007413 Examples :
7414 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007415 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007416
7417 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7418 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7419 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7420
7421
7422 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7423 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7424 backend http
7425 mode http
7426 balance roundrobin
7427 stick on src table https
7428 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7429 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7430 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7431
7432 backend https
7433 mode tcp
7434 balance roundrobin
7435 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7436 stick on src
7437 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7438 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7439
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007440 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007441
7442
7443stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7444 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7446 no | no | yes | yes
7447
7448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007449 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007450 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7451 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7452 server is selected.
7453
7454 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7455 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7456 the "stick-table" statement.
7457
7458 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7459 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7460 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7461 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7462 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7463 address.
7464
7465 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7466 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7467 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7468 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7469 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7470 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7471 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7472 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7473 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7474 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7475
7476 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7477 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7478 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7479 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7480 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7481 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7482 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7483
7484 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7485 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7486 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7487 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7488
7489 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7490 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7491 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7492 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7493 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7494 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007495 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7496 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7497 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7498 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7499 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7500 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007501
7502 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7503 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7504 the request.
7505
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007506 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7507 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7508 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007510 Example :
7511 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7512 # last 30 minutes
7513 backend pop
7514 mode tcp
7515 balance roundrobin
7516 stick store-request src
7517 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7518 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7519 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7520
7521 backend smtp
7522 mode tcp
7523 balance roundrobin
7524 stick match src table pop
7525 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7526 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7527
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007528 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007529 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007530
7531
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007532stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007533 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7534 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007535 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007537 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007538
7539 Arguments :
7540 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7541 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7542 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7543 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7544
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007545 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7546 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7547 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7548 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7549
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007550 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7551 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7552 instance.
7553
7554 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7555 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7556 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7557 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7558 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7559 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007560 to 32 characters.
7561
7562 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7563 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7564 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007565 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007566 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7567 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007568
7569 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007570 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7571 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007572 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7573 increase.
7574
7575 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007576 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7577 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7578 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007579
7580 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7581 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7582 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7583 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7584 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7585 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7586 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7587 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7588 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7589 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7590 parameter (see below).
7591
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007592 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7593 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7594 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7595 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7596 soft restart.
7597
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007598 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7599 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007600
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007601 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7602 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7603 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7604 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7605 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007606 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007607 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7608 if not expiration delay is specified.
7609
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007610 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7611 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7612 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7613 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007614 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7615 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7616 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7617 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7618 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7619 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7620 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7621 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7622 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7623 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7624 types and their arguments.
7625
7626 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7627 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7628 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7629 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7630
7631 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7632 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7633 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7634 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7635
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007636 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7637 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7638 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7639 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7640 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7641 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7642
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007643 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7644 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7645 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7646 they were received.
7647
7648 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7649 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7650 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7651 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7652 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7653
7654 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7655 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7656 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7657 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7658 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7659
7660 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7661 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7662 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7663
7664 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7665 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7666 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7667 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7668 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7669
7670 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7671 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7672 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7673 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7674 the client side.
7675
7676 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7677 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7678 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7679 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7680 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7681 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7682 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7683
7684 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7685 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7686 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7687 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7688 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7689 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7690 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7691
7692 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7693 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7694 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7695 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7696 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7697 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7698
7699 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7700 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7701 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7702 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7703
7704 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7705 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7706 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7707 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7708 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7709 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7710 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7711 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7712 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7713 recommended for better fairness.
7714
7715 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7716 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7717 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7718 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7719
7720 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7721 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7722 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7723 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7724 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7725 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7726 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7727 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7728 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7729 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007730
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007731 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7732 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007733 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7734 reference it.
7735
7736 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7737 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7738 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7739 as an exclusive stickiness.
7740
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007741 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7742 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7743 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7744 something that can be ignored.
7745
7746 Example:
7747 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7748 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7749 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7750 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7751
7752 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007753 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007754
7755
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007756stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7757 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | no | yes | yes
7760
7761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007762 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007763 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7764 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7765 server is selected.
7766
7767 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7768 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7769 the "stick-table" statement.
7770
7771 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7772 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7773 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7774 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7775
7776 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7777 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7778 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7779 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7780 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7781 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007782 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007783 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7784 rules.
7785
7786 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7787 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7788 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7789 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7790 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7791 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7792 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7793
7794 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7795 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7796 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7797 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7798
7799 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7800 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7801 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7802 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7803 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7804 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007805 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7806 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7807 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7808 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7809 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7810 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7811 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7812 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7813 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007814
7815 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7816
7817 Example :
7818 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7819 backend https
7820 mode tcp
7821 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007822 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007823 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007824
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007825 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7826 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7827
7828 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7829 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7830 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7831
7832 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7833 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007834
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007835 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7836 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7837 # at offset 44.
7838
7839 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7840 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7841
7842 # Learn on response if server hello.
7843 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007844
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007845 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7846 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7847
7848 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7849 extraction.
7850
7851
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007852tcp-check connect [params*]
7853 Opens a new connection
7854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7855 no | no | yes | yes
7856
7857 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7858 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7859 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7860
7861 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7862 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7863 of the sequence.
7864
7865 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7866 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7867 do.
7868
7869 Parameters :
7870 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7871 use the TCP connection.
7872
7873 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7874 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7875 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7876
7877 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7878
7879 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7880
7881 Examples:
7882 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7883 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7884 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7885 option tcp-check
7886 tcp-check connect
7887 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7888 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7889 tcp-check send \r\n
7890 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7891 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7892 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7893 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7894 tcp-check send \r\n
7895 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7896 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7897
7898 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7899 option tcp-check
7900 tcp-check connect port 110
7901 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7902 tcp-check connect port 143
7903 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7904 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7905
7906 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7907
7908
7909tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7910 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 no | no | yes | yes
7913
7914 Arguments :
7915 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7916 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7917 binary.
7918 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7919 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7920 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7921
7922 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7923 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7924 with the usual backslash ('\').
7925 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7926 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7927 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7928 used upper or lower case.
7929
7930
7931 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7932
7933 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7934 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7935 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7936 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7937 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7938 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7939 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7940 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7941
7942 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7943 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7944 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7945 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7946 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7947 expression.
7948
7949 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7950 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7951 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7952 this exact hexadecimal string.
7953 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7954
7955 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7956 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7957 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7958 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7959 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7960 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7961 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7962 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7963 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7964 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7965 the null character.
7966
7967 Examples :
7968 # perform a POP check
7969 option tcp-check
7970 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7971
7972 # perform an IMAP check
7973 option tcp-check
7974 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7975
7976 # look for the redis master server
7977 option tcp-check
7978 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7979 tcp-check expect +PONG
7980 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7981 tcp-check expect string role:master
7982 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7983 tcp-check expect string +OK
7984
7985
7986 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7987 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7988
7989
7990tcp-check send <data>
7991 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 no | no | yes | yes
7994
7995 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7996 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7997
7998 Examples :
7999 # look for the redis master server
8000 option tcp-check
8001 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8002 tcp-check expect string role:master
8003
8004 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8005 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8006
8007
8008tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8009 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8010 tcp health check
8011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8012 no | no | yes | yes
8013
8014 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8015 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8016 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8017 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8018 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8019 hexadecimal string.
8020 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8021
8022 Examples :
8023 # redis check in binary
8024 option tcp-check
8025 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8026 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8027
8028
8029 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8030 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8031
8032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008033tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8034 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8036 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008037 Arguments :
8038 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008039 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8040 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008042 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008043
8044 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8045 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008046 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8047 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8048 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8049 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8050 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8051 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008053 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8054 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8055 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8056 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008057
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008058 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008059 - accept :
8060 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8061 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8062 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008064 - reject :
8065 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8066 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8067 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8068 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8069 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8070 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8071 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8072 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8073 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8074 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8075 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8076 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008077
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008078 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8079 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8080 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8081 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8082 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8083 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8084 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8085 hosts.
8086
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008087 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8088 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8089 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8090 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8091 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8092 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8093 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8094 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8095 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008096 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8097 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008098
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008099 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008100 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008101 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008102 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008103 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8104 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008105 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008106 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8107 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8108 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8109 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8110 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008112 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008113 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008114 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008115 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8116 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8117 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8118 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008120 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8121 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8122 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8123 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008125 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8126 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8127 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8128 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8129 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008130 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8131 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8132 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8133 layer7 information is extracted.
8134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008135 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8136 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8137 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8138 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8139 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008141 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8142 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8143 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008145 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8146 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8147 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008149 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008150 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008151 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008153 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8154 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8155 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008157 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008158 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8159 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008160
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008161 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8162
8163 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8164
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008165 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008167 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008168
8169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008170tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8171 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008173 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008174 Arguments :
8175 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008176 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008177 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8178 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008180 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008182 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8183 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8184 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8185 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8186 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008188 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8189 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8190 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8191 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008192 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8193 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8194 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8195 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8196 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8197 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008198 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008199 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008201 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8202 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8203 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8204 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008205
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008206 Four types of actions are supported :
8207 - accept : the request is accepted
8208 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8209 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008210 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008211 - lua <function>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008213 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8214 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008215
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008216 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8217 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8218 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8219 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8220 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8221 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008223 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008224 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8225 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008227 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008228 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8229 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8230 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8231 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008232 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8233 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8234 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008235
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008236 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008237 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8238 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8239 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008240
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008241 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8242 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8243 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8244 documentation.
8245
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008246 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008247 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8248 # and reject everything else.
8249 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8250 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008251 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008252 tcp-request content reject
8253
8254 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008255 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8256 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8257 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008258 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008259
8260 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8261 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8262 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008263 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008264 tcp-request content reject
8265
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008266 Example:
8267 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8268 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008269 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008270
8271 Example:
8272 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8273 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008274 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008276 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8277 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8278
8279 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008280 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008281 # protecting all our sites
8282 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008283 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8284 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008285 ...
8286 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8287
8288 backend http_dynamic
8289 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008290 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008291 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008292 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8293 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8294 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008295 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008297 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008299 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008300
8301
8302tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8303 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008305 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008306 Arguments :
8307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8309 as explained at the top of this document.
8310
8311 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8312 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8313 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8314 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8315 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8316
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008317 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8318 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8319 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8320 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8321
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008322 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8323 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008324 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008325 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008326 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8327 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8328 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8329 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008330
8331 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8332 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8333 it pass through unaffected.
8334
8335 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8336 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8337 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008338 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008339 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8340 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008341 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8342 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8343 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008344
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008345 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008346 "timeout client".
8347
8348
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008349tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8350 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8352 no | no | yes | yes
8353 Arguments :
8354 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008355 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008356
8357 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8358
8359 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8360 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8361 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008362 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8363 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008364
8365 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8366
8367 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8368 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8369 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8370 inserted.
8371
8372 Two types of actions are supported :
8373 - accept :
8374 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8375 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8376 the rules evaluation.
8377
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008378 - close :
8379 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8380 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8381 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8382 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8383 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8384 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008385 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008386 protocols.
8387
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008388 - reject :
8389 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8390 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008391 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008392
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008393 - lua <function>
8394 Executes Lua.
8395
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008396 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8397 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8398 for changing the default action to a reject.
8399
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008400 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8401 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8402 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8403 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008404 period.
8405
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008406 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8407 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8408 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8409 documentation.
8410
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008411 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8412
8413 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8414
8415
8416tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 no | no | yes | yes
8420 Arguments :
8421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8423 as explained at the top of this document.
8424
8425 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8426
8427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008428timeout check <timeout>
8429 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8430 established.
8431
8432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments:
8435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8437 as explained at the top of this document.
8438
8439 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8440 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8441 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8442 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008443 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8444 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8445 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008446
8447 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8448 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8449
8450 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8451 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008452 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008453
8454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8456 forget about it.
8457
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008458 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8459 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008460
8461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008462timeout client <timeout>
8463timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8464 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8466 yes | yes | yes | no
8467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008468 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8470 as explained at the top of this document.
8471
8472 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8473 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8474 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8475 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8476 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8477 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8478 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8479 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008480 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008481 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008482 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8483 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008484 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8485 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008486
8487 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8488 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8489 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8490 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8491 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8492 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8493
8494 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8495 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8496 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8497
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008498 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008499
8500
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008501timeout client-fin <timeout>
8502 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8504 yes | yes | yes | no
8505 Arguments :
8506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8508 as explained at the top of this document.
8509
8510 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8511 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8512 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8513 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8514 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8515 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8516 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8517 down in one direction.
8518
8519 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8520 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8521 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8522
8523 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8524
8525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008526timeout connect <timeout>
8527timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8528 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8530 yes | no | yes | yes
8531 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008532 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008533 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8534 as explained at the top of this document.
8535
8536 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008537 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008538 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008539 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008540 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8541 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008542
8543 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8544 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8545 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8546 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8547 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8548 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8549
8550 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8551 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8552 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8553
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008554 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8555 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008556
8557
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008558timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8559 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 yes | yes | yes | yes
8562 Arguments :
8563 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8565 as explained at the top of this document.
8566
8567 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8568 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8569 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8570 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8571 once the request has started to present itself.
8572
8573 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8574 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8575 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8576 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8577 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8578
8579 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8580 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8581 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8582 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8583
8584 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8585 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8586 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8587 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8588 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008589 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008590
8591 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8592 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8593 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8594 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8595
8596 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8597
8598
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008599timeout http-request <timeout>
8600 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008602 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008604 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008605 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8606 as explained at the top of this document.
8607
8608 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8609 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8610 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8611 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8612 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8613 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8614 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008615 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8616 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8617 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8618 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8619 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008620 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8621 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008622
8623 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8624 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008625 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8626 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008627
8628 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8629 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8630 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8631 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8632 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8633
8634 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008635 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8636 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8637 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008638
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008639 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8640 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008641
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008642
8643timeout queue <timeout>
8644 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8646 yes | no | yes | yes
8647 Arguments :
8648 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8649 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8650 as explained at the top of this document.
8651
8652 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8653 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8654 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8655 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8656 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8657
8658 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8659 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8660 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8661 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8662
8663 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8664
8665
8666timeout server <timeout>
8667timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8668 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8670 yes | no | yes | yes
8671 Arguments :
8672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8674 as explained at the top of this document.
8675
8676 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8677 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8678 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8679 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8680 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8681 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8682 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8683
8684 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8685 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8686 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8687 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8688 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008689 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008690 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008691 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8692 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8693 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8694 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008695
8696 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8697 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8698 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8699 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8700 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8701 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8702
8703 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8704 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8705 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8706
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008707 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008708
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008709
8710timeout server-fin <timeout>
8711 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8713 yes | no | yes | yes
8714 Arguments :
8715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8717 as explained at the top of this document.
8718
8719 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8720 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8721 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8722 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8723 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8724 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8725 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8726 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8727 situations, it should not be needed.
8728
8729 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8730 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8731 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8732
8733 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8734
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008735
8736timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008737 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 yes | yes | yes | yes
8740 Arguments :
8741 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8743 as explained at the top of this document.
8744
8745 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8746 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8747 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8748
8749 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8750 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8751 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8752 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008753 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008754
8755 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8756
8757
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008758timeout tunnel <timeout>
8759 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8761 yes | no | yes | yes
8762 Arguments :
8763 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8764 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8765 as explained at the top of this document.
8766
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008767 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008768 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8769 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8770 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8771 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8772 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8773 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8774 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8775 specified.
8776
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008777 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8778 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8779 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8780 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8781 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8782 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8783 state.
8784
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008785 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8786 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8787 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8788 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8789 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8790
8791 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8792 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8793 forget about it.
8794
8795 Example :
8796 defaults http
8797 option http-server-close
8798 timeout connect 5s
8799 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008800 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008801 timeout server 30s
8802 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8803
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008804 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008805
8806
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008807transparent (deprecated)
8808 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008810 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008811 Arguments : none
8812
8813 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8814 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8815 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8816 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8817 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8818 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8819 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8820 appropriate server.
8821
8822 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8823
8824 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8825 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8826
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008827 See also: "option transparent"
8828
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008829unique-id-format <string>
8830 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | no
8833 Arguments :
8834 <string> is a log-format string.
8835
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008836 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8837 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8838 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8839 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008840
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008841 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8842 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8843 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8844 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8845 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8846 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8847 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8848 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008849
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008850 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8851 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008852
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008853 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008854
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008855 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008856
8857 will generate:
8858
8859 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8860
8861 See also: "unique-id-header"
8862
8863unique-id-header <name>
8864 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 yes | yes | yes | no
8867 Arguments :
8868 <name> is the name of the header.
8869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008870 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8871 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008872
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008873 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008874
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008875 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008876 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8877
8878 will generate:
8879
8880 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8881
8882 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008883
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008884use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008885 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8887 no | yes | yes | no
8888 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008889 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8890 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008891
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008892 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8893 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008894
8895 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8896 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8897 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008898 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8899 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8900 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8901 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008902
8903 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8904 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8905 assign the backend.
8906
8907 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8908 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8909 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8910 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8911 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8912 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8913
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008914 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008915 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008916 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8917 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8918 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8919
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008920 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8921 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8922 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8923 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8924 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8925 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8926 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8927 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8928 cannot be forced from the request.
8929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008930 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008931 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8932 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8933
8934 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8935 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008936
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008937
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008938use-server <server> if <condition>
8939use-server <server> unless <condition>
8940 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8942 no | no | yes | yes
8943 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008944 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008945
8946 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8947
8948 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8949 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8950 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8951
8952 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8953 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8954 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8955 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8956 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8957 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8958 matches will assign the server.
8959
8960 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8961 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8962 with the next rules until one matches.
8963
8964 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8965 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8966 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8967 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8968
8969 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8970 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8971 stripped.
8972
8973 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8974 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8975 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8976 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8977
8978 Example :
8979 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8980 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8981 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8982 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8983 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8984 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8985 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8986 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8987 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8988
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008989 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008990
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008991
89925. Bind and Server options
8993--------------------------
8994
8995The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8996depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8997settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8998written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8999described in this section.
9000
9001
90025.1. Bind options
9003-----------------
9004
9005The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9006as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9007no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9008parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9009while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9010provided immediately after the setting name.
9011
9012The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9013
9014accept-proxy
9015 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009016 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9017 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009018 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9019 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9020 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9021 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9022 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9023 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9024 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009025 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9026 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009027
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009028alpn <protocols>
9029 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9030 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9031 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9032 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9033 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9034 initial NPN extension.
9035
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009036backlog <backlog>
9037 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9038 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9039
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009040ecdhe <named curve>
9041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009042 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9043 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009044
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009045ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9047 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9048 client's certificate.
9049
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009050ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9052 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9053 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9054 error is ignored.
9055
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009056ca-sign-file <cafile>
9057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9058 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9059 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9060 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9061 'generate-certificates' for details.
9062
9063ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9065 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9066 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9067 'generate-certificates' for details.
9068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009069ciphers <ciphers>
9070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9071 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009072 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009073 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9074 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9075
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009076crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9078 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9079 to verify client's certificate.
9080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009081crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9083 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9084 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9085 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9086 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9087 file.
9088
9089 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9090 are loaded.
9091
9092 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009093 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009094 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9095 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9096 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9097 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9098 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9099 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9100 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009101
9102 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9103 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9104 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9105 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009106 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9107 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009108
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009109 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009110
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009111 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9112 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009113 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009114 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9115 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9116 clients).
9117
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009118 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9119 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9120 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9121 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9122 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9123 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9124 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9125 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9126 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9127 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9128 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9129 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9130 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9131
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009132 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9133 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9134 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9135 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9136 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9137
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009138crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9140 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009141 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009142 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009143
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009144crt-list <file>
9145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009146 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9147 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009148
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009149 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009150
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009151 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9152 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9153 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9154 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9155 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9156 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9157 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9158 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009160defer-accept
9161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9162 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9163 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9164 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9165 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9166 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9167 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9168 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9169 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9170 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9171 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9172
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009173force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009174 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009175 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009176 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9177 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009178
9179force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009180 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009181 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9182 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009183
9184force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009185 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009186 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9187 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009188
9189force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009190 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009191 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9192 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009193
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009194generate-certificates
9195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9196 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9197 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9198 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9199 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9200 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9201 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9202 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9203 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9204 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9205 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9206
9207 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9208 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9209 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9210 certificate is used many times.
9211
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009212gid <gid>
9213 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9214 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9215 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9216 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9217 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9218
9219group <group>
9220 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9221 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9222 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9223 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9224 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9225
9226id <id>
9227 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9228 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9229 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9230 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9231
9232interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009233 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9234 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9235 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9236 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9237 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9238 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9239 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009240
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009241level <level>
9242 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9243 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9244 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9245 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9246 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9247 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9248 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9249 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9250 counters).
9251 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9252 all counters).
9253
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009254maxconn <maxconn>
9255 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9256 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9257 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9258 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9259 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9260 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9261 eat all memory.
9262
9263mode <mode>
9264 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9265 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9266 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9267 UNIX sockets.
9268
9269mss <maxseg>
9270 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9271 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9272 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9273 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9274 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9275 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9276 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9277 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9278 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9279 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9280 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9281
9282name <name>
9283 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9284 page.
9285
9286nice <nice>
9287 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9288 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9289 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9290 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9291 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9292 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9293 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9294 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9295 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9296 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9297 one for an RDP socket.
9298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009299no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009301 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009302 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009303 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9304 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009305 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009306
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009307no-tls-tickets
9308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9309 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9310 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009311 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9312 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009313
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009314no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009316 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009317 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009318 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9319 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9320 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009321
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009322no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009324 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009325 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009326 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9327 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9328 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009330no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009332 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009333 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009334 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9335 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9336 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009337
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009338npn <protocols>
9339 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9340 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9341 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9342 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009343 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9344 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009345
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009346process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9347 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9348 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9349 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9350 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9351 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9352 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9353 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009354 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9355 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9356 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9357 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9358 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9359 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9360 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009361
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009362ssl
9363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009364 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009365 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9366 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9367 to deciphered contents.
9368
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009369strict-sni
9370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9371 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9372 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9373 See the "crt" option for more information.
9374
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009375tcp-ut <delay>
9376 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9377 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9378 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9379 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9380 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9381 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9382 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9383 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9384 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9385 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9386 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9387
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009388tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009389 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009390 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9391 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9392 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9393 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9394 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9395 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9396 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009397 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9398 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9399 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009400
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009401tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9402 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9403 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9404 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9405 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9406 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9407 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9408 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9409 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9410 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9411 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009413transparent
9414 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9415 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9416 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9417 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9418 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9419 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9420 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9421 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9422 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9423 so check for support with your vendor.
9424
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009425v4v6
9426 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9427 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9428 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9429 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009430 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009431
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009432v6only
9433 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9434 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9435 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009436 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9437 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009439uid <uid>
9440 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9441 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9442 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9443 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9444 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9445
9446user <user>
9447 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9448 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9449 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9450 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9451 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9452
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009453verify [none|optional|required]
9454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9455 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9456 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9457 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9458 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009459 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9460 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9461 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9462 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020094645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009465------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009467The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9468which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9469arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9470settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9471after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9472Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9473address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009475 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009476 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009478The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009479
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009480addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009481 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9482 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9483 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9484 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9485 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009487 Supported in default-server: No
9488
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009489agent-check
9490 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009491 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9492 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9493 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9494 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009495
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009496 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009497 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009498 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9499 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9500 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009501
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009502 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9503 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009504
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009505 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9506 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9507 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009509 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9510 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9511 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009513 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9514 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9515 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9516 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9517 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9518 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9519 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009520
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009521 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9522 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009523
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009524 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9525 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9526 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9527 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9528 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9529 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9530 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9531 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9532 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009533
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009534 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9535 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009536 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9537 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9538 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9539 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009540
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009541 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9542 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009543
9544 Supported in default-server: No
9545
9546agent-inter <delay>
9547 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9548 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9549
9550 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9551 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9552 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9553 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9554 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9555 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9556 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9557 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9558 of backends use the same servers.
9559
9560 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9561
9562 Supported in default-server: Yes
9563
9564agent-port <port>
9565 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9566
9567 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9568
9569 Supported in default-server: Yes
9570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009571backup
9572 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9573 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9574 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9575 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9576 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9577 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009579 Supported in default-server: No
9580
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009581ca-file <cafile>
9582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9583 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9584 server's certificate.
9585
9586 Supported in default-server: No
9587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009588check
9589 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009590 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9591 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9592 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9593 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9594 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9595 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9596 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009597 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9598 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9599 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009601 Supported in default-server: No
9602
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009603check-send-proxy
9604 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9605 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9606 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9607 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9608 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9609 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9610 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9611
9612 Supported in default-server: No
9613
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009614check-ssl
9615 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9616 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9617 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9618 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009619 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009620 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9621 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9622 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9623 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9624
9625 Supported in default-server: No
9626
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009627ciphers <ciphers>
9628 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009629 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009630 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9631 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9632 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9633 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9634 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9635 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9636
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009637 Supported in default-server: No
9638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009639cookie <value>
9640 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9641 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9642 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9643 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9644 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9645 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9646 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009648 Supported in default-server: No
9649
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009650crl-file <crlfile>
9651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9652 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9653 to verify server's certificate.
9654
9655 Supported in default-server: No
9656
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009657crt <cert>
9658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9659 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9660 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9661 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9662 certificate request.
9663
9664 Supported in default-server: No
9665
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009666disabled
9667 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9668 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9669 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9670 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9671 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9672
9673 Supported in default-server: No
9674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009675error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009676 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9677 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9678 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009680 Supported in default-server: Yes
9681
9682 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009684fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009685 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9686 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9687 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009689 Supported in default-server: Yes
9690
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009691force-sslv3
9692 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9693 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009694 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009696
9697 Supported in default-server: No
9698
9699force-tlsv10
9700 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009701 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9702 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009703
9704 Supported in default-server: No
9705
9706force-tlsv11
9707 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009708 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9709 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009710
9711 Supported in default-server: No
9712
9713force-tlsv12
9714 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009715 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9716 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009717
9718 Supported in default-server: No
9719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009720id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009721 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9722 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9723 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009725 Supported in default-server: No
9726
9727inter <delay>
9728fastinter <delay>
9729downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009730 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9731 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9732 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9733 between checks depending on the server state :
9734
9735 Server state | Interval used
9736 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9737 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9738 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9739 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9740 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9741 or yet unchecked. |
9742 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9743 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9744 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009746 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9747 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9748 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9749 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009750 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9751 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9752 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9753 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9754 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009756 Supported in default-server: Yes
9757
9758maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009759 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9760 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9761 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9762 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9763 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9764 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9765 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9766 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009768 Supported in default-server: Yes
9769
9770maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009771 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9772 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9773 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9774 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9775 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9776 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9777 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009779 Supported in default-server: Yes
9780
9781minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009782 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9783 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9784 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9785 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9786 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9787 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009788 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009789 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009791 Supported in default-server: Yes
9792
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009793no-ssl-reuse
9794 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9795 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9796 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9797 and for paranoid users.
9798
9799 Supported in default-server: No
9800
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009801no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009802 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9803 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009804 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009805
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009806 Supported in default-server: No
9807
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009808no-tls-tickets
9809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9810 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9811 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009812 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9813 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009814
9815 Supported in default-server: No
9816
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009817no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009818 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009819 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9820 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009821 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9822 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9823 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009824
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009825 Supported in default-server: No
9826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009827no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009828 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009829 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9830 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009831 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9832 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9833 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009834
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009835 Supported in default-server: No
9836
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009837no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009838 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009839 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9840 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009841 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9842 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9843 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009844
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009845 Supported in default-server: No
9846
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009847non-stick
9848 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9849 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9850 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9851
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009852 Supported in default-server: No
9853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009854observe <mode>
9855 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9856 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9857 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9858 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9859 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9860 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009861 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009863 Supported in default-server: No
9864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009865 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009867on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009868 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9869 Currently, four modes are available:
9870 - fastinter: force fastinter
9871 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9872 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9873 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9874 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009876 Supported in default-server: Yes
9877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009878 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9879
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009880on-marked-down <action>
9881 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9882 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009883 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9884 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9885 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9886 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9887 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9888 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9889 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9890 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009891
9892 Actions are disabled by default
9893
9894 Supported in default-server: Yes
9895
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009896on-marked-up <action>
9897 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9898 Currently one action is available:
9899 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9900 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9901 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9902 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9903 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9904 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9905 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9906 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9907
9908 Actions are disabled by default
9909
9910 Supported in default-server: Yes
9911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009912port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009913 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9914 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9915 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9916 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9917 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9918 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009920 Supported in default-server: Yes
9921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009922redir <prefix>
9923 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9924 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9925 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9926 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9927 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9928 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9929 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9930 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009931 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009932 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9933 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9934 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9935 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9936 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9937
9938 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009940 Supported in default-server: No
9941
9942rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9944 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9945 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009947 Supported in default-server: Yes
9948
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +02009949resolve-prefer <family>
9950 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
9951 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
9952 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
9953 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
9954
9955 Default value: ipv4
9956
9957 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
9958
9959resolvers <id>
9960 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
9961 hostname.
9962
9963 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
9964
9965 See also chapter 5.3
9966
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009967send-proxy
9968 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9969 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9970 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9971 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9972 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9973 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9974 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9975 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9976 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009977 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9978 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9979 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9980 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9981 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009982
9983 Supported in default-server: No
9984
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009985send-proxy-v2
9986 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9987 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9988 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9989 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9990 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9991 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9992 option of the "bind" keyword.
9993
9994 Supported in default-server: No
9995
9996send-proxy-v2-ssl
9997 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9998 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9999 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10000 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10001 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10002 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10003 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10004 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10005
10006 Supported in default-server: No
10007
10008send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10009 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10010 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10011 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10012 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10013 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10014 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10015 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10016 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10017 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10018
10019 Supported in default-server: No
10020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010021slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010022 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10023 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10024 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10025 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10026 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10027 parameters :
10028
10029 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10030 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10031
10032 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10033 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10034 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10035 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10036
10037 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10038 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10039 seen as failed.
10040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010041 Supported in default-server: Yes
10042
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010043source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010044source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010045source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010046 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10047 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10048 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10049 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10050
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010051 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10052 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10053 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10054 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10055 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10056 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10057 server.
10058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010059 Supported in default-server: No
10060
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010061ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010062 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10063 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10064 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10065 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10066 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10067 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010068 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010069
10070 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010072track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010073 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10074 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10075 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10076 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010077 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010079 Supported in default-server: No
10080
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010081verify [none|required]
10082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010083 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10084 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10085 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10086 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010087 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10088 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10089 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010090
10091 Supported in default-server: No
10092
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010093verifyhost <hostname>
10094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10095 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10096 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10097 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10098 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10099 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10100
10101 Supported in default-server: No
10102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010103weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010104 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10105 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10106 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010107 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10108 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10109 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10110 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10111 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10112 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010114 Supported in default-server: Yes
10115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010116
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200101175.3 Server IP address resolution using DNS
10118------------------------------------------
10119
10120HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10121IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10122configuration, at startup.
10123This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10124can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10125workload.
10126This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10127resolution at run time.
10128Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10129carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10130
10131
101325.3.1 Global overview
10133---------------------
10134
10135As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10136different steps of the process life:
10137
10138 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10139 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10140 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10141
10142 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10143 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10144 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10145
10146A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10147 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10148 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10149 resolution to know this new IP.
10150
10151A few things important to notice:
10152 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10153 first valid response.
10154
10155 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10156 servers return an error.
10157
10158
101595.3.2 The resolvers section
10160---------------------------
10161
10162This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10163HAProxy.
10164There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10165many name servers.
10166
10167resolvers <resolvers id>
10168 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10169
10170A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10171
10172nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10173 DNS server description:
10174 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10175 <ip> : IP address of the server
10176 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10177
10178hold <status> <period>
10179 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10180 on last resolution <status>
10181 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10182 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10183 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10184 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10185
10186 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10187
10188 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10189 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10190 the healch check.
10191
10192resolve_retries <nb>
10193 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10194 giving up.
10195 Default value: 3
10196
10197timeout <event> <time>
10198 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10199 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10200 events available are:
10201 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10202 been received.
10203 Default value: 1s
10204 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10205 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10206
10207Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10208
10209 resolvers mydns
10210 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10211 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10212 resolve_retries 3
10213 timeout retry 1s
10214 hold valid 10s
10215
10216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102176. HTTP header manipulation
10218---------------------------
10219
10220In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10221response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10222request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10223which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010224against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010225
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010226If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10227to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10228but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10229HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10230stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10231because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10232a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10233still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010235This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10236in section 4.2 :
10237
10238 - reqadd <string>
10239 - reqallow <search>
10240 - reqiallow <search>
10241 - reqdel <search>
10242 - reqidel <search>
10243 - reqdeny <search>
10244 - reqideny <search>
10245 - reqpass <search>
10246 - reqipass <search>
10247 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10248 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10249 - reqtarpit <search>
10250 - reqitarpit <search>
10251 - rspadd <string>
10252 - rspdel <search>
10253 - rspidel <search>
10254 - rspdeny <search>
10255 - rspideny <search>
10256 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10257 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10258
10259With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10260is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10261parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10262prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10263Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10264
10265 \t for a tab
10266 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10267 \n for a new line (LF)
10268 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10269 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10270 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10271 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10272 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10273
10274The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10275portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10276above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10277regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
102789 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10279is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10280
10281The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10282after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10283
10284Notes related to these keywords :
10285---------------------------------
10286 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10287 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10288 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10289
10290 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10291 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10292 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10293
10294 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10295 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10296 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10297 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10298 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10299
10300 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10301 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10302 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10303 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10304 useless headers before adding new ones.
10305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010306 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010307 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10308
10309 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10310 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10311 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10312
10313 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10314 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010315 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010316
10317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103187. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10319----------------------------------
10320
10321Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10322client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10323The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10324these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10325but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10326data called patterns.
10327
10328
103297.1. ACL basics
10330---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010331
10332The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10333content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10334from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10335simple :
10336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010337 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010338 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010339 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10340 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10343adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010344
10345In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010347 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010348
10349This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10350Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10351and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010352an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10353conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10354as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10355are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010356
10357ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10358'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10359which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10360
10361There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10362performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010364The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10365specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10366this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010367methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10368ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010369
10370Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10371 - boolean
10372 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10373 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10374 - string
10375 - data block
10376
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010377Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10378converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10379would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10380The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10381which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10382
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010383Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10384keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10385fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10386which are summarized in the table below :
10387
10388 +---------------------+-----------------+
10389 | Sample or converter | Default |
10390 | output type | matching method |
10391 +---------------------+-----------------+
10392 | boolean | bool |
10393 +---------------------+-----------------+
10394 | integer | int |
10395 +---------------------+-----------------+
10396 | ip | ip |
10397 +---------------------+-----------------+
10398 | string | str |
10399 +---------------------+-----------------+
10400 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10401 +---------------------+-----------------+
10402
10403Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10404matching method, see below.
10405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010406The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10407 - boolean
10408 - integer or integer range
10409 - IP address / network
10410 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10411 - regular expression
10412 - hex block
10413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010414The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10415
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010416 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10417 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010418 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010419 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010420 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010421 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010422 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010424The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10425read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10426if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10427lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10428will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10429beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10430a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10431lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10432exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10433
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010434The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10435parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10436ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10437a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10438check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10439
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010440The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10441socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10442file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010444Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10445loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10446
10447 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10448
10449In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10450the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10451case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10452as well.
10453
10454The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10455sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10456do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10457methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10458is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10459obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10460followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10461default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10462that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10463string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10464
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010465The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10466By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10467string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10468resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10469server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10470waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10471flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10472function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010474There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10475sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10476be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010477
10478 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10479 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010480 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10481 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10482 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10483 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010484
10485 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10486 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010488
10489 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010491
10492 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010493 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010494
10495 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10496 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10497
10498 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10499 binary or string samples.
10500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010501 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10502 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10505 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10506 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10509 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010511 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10512 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010514 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10515 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10518 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010519 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10522 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10523 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010524
10525For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10526request, it is possible to do :
10527
10528 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10529
10530In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10531buffer, one would use the following acl :
10532
10533 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10534
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010535On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10536possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10537
10538 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010540All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10541criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10542method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10543to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10544criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10545the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010548the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10549For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10552 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10553 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10554 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010555
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010556
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010557The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10558types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10559combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10560brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10561default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563 +-------------------------------------------------+
10564 | Input sample type |
10565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010566 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10568 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010570 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010572 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010574 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010575 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010576 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010578 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010580 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010582 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010584 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010586 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010588 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010590 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10592 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010594
10595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105967.1.1. Matching booleans
10597------------------------
10598
10599In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10600Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10601When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10602that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10603
10604Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10605return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10606"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200106097.1.2. Matching integers
10610------------------------
10611
10612Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10613enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10614to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10615
10616Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10617matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10618lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010619
10620For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10621unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10622representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10623
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010624As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10625two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10626instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10627ranges and operators.
10628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010629For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010630operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10631Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10632of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010634Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010635
10636 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10637 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10638 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10639 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10640 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010642For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010643
10644 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10645
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010646This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10647
10648 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10649
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200106517.1.3. Matching strings
10652-----------------------
10653
10654String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10655different forms :
10656
10657 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10658 patterns ;
10659
10660 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10661 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10662
10663 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10664 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10665
10666 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10667 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10668
10669 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10670 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10671 matches.
10672
10673 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10674 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10675 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010676
10677String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10678exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10679characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10680string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10681to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010682before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010683
10684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200106857.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10686---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010687
10688Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10689they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10690possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10691passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10692the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010693the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10694match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010695
10696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200106977.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10698-------------------------------------
10699
10700It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10701not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10702a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10703to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10704digits may be used upper or lower case.
10705
10706Example :
10707 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10708 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10709
10710
107117.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10712---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010713
10714IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10715netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10716within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010717host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010718difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10719at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10720does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10721parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010722
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010723IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10724Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10725trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10726IPv6 patterns.
10727
10728HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10729following situations :
10730 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10731 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10732 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10733 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10734 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10735 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10736 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10737 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10738 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10739 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741
107427.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10743----------------------------------
10744
10745Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10746combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10747
10748 - AND (implicit)
10749 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10750 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10757indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010759For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10760"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10761requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10762is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10763
10764 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10765 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10766 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10767 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10768
10769To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10770and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10771
10772 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10773 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10774 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10775 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10776
10777 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10778 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10779 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10780 use_backend www if host_www
10781
10782It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10783expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10784be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10785the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10786
10787 The following rule :
10788
10789 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10790 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10791
10792 Can also be written that way :
10793
10794 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10795
10796It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10797to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10798simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10799sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10800good use is the following :
10801
10802 With named ACLs :
10803
10804 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10805 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10806 monitor fail if site_dead
10807
10808 With anonymous ACLs :
10809
10810 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10811
10812See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10813
10814
108157.3. Fetching samples
10816---------------------
10817
10818Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10819against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10820sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10821ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10822of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10823available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10824
10825This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10826Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10827compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10828deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10829
10830The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10831matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10832method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10833indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10834
10835As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10836when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10837mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10838the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10839ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10840
10841Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10842multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10843when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10844incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10845are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10846is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10847all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10848
10849Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10850 - name
10851 - name(arg1)
10852 - name(arg1,arg2)
10853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010854
108557.3.1. Converters
10856-----------------
10857
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010858Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10859of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10860is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10861was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10862has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10863unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10864
10865These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10866sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10867the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10868support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010869
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010870A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10871support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10872supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10873(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10874bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010877
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010878add(<value>)
10879 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10880 result as an unsigned integer.
10881
10882and(<value>)
10883 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10884 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10885
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010886base64
10887 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10888 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10889 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10890
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010891bool
10892 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10893 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10894 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10895 presence of a flag).
10896
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010897bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10898 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10899 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10900 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10901
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010902cpl
10903 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10904 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10905
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010906crc32([<avalanche>])
10907 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10908 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10909 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10910 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10911 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10912 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10913 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10914 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10915 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10916 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10917 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10918
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020010919da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
10920 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
10921 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
10922 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
10923 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
10924 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
10925 configuration language.
10926
10927 Example:
10928 frontend www
10929 bind *:8881
10930 default_backend servers
10931 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
10932
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010933div(<value>)
10934 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10935 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10936 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10937
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010938djb2([<avalanche>])
10939 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10940 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10941 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10942 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10943 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10944 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10945 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010946 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10947 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010948
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010949even
10950 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10951 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10952
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010953field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10954 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10955 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10956 list of chars.
10957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010958hex
10959 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10960 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10961 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10962 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010963
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010964http_date([<offset>])
10965 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10966 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10967 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10968 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10969 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10970 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010972in_table(<table>)
10973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10975 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10976 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10977 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10978
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010979ipmask(<mask>)
10980 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10981 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10982 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10983 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10984
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010985json([<input-code>])
10986 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10987 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10988 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10989 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10990 of errors:
10991 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10992 bytes, ...)
10993 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10994 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10995
10996 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10997 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10998 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10999 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11000 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11001 are :
11002 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11003 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11004 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11005 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11006 error ;
11007 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11008 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11009
11010 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11011 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11012
11013 Example:
11014 capture request header user-agent len 150
11015 capture request header Host len 15
11016 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11017
11018 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11019 GET / HTTP/1.0
11020 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11021
11022 Output log:
11023 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011025language(<value>[,<default>])
11026 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11027 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11028 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11029 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11030 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11031 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11032 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11033 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11034 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11035 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11036 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11037 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011038
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011039 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011041 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11042 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011043
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011044 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11045 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11046 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11047 use_backend spanish if es
11048 use_backend french if fr
11049 use_backend english if en
11050 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011051
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011052lower
11053 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11054 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11055 type. The result is of type string.
11056
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011057ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11058 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11059 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11060 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11061 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11062 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11063 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11064
11065 Example :
11066
11067 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11068 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11069 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011071map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11072map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11073map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11074 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11075 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11076 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11077 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11078 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11079 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11080 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11081 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011082
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011083 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11084 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11085 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011087 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11088 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011089
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011090 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11091 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11092 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011094 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11095 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011096 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11098 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11100 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11102 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11103 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11104 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11105 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11106 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11108 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011110
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011111 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11112 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11113 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11114 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11115 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011117 Example :
11118
11119 # this is a comment and is ignored
11120 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11121 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11122 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11123 | | | `---------- value
11124 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11125 | `---------------------------- key
11126 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11127
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011128mod(<value>)
11129 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11130 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
11131
11132mul(<value>)
11133 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
11134 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
11135 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
11136
11137neg
11138 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
11139 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
11140 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
11141 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11142
11143not
11144 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11145 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11146 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11147 absence of a flag).
11148
11149odd
11150 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
11151 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11152
11153or(<value>)
11154 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11155 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11156
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011157regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011158 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11159 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11160 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11161 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11162 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11163 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11164 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11165 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11166 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11167 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11168 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11169 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11170 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11171
11172 Example :
11173
11174 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11175 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11176 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11177 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11178
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011179capture-req(<id>)
11180 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11181 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11182
11183 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11184 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11185 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11186
11187capture-res(<id>)
11188 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11189 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11190
11191 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11192 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11193 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11194
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011195sdbm([<avalanche>])
11196 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11197 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11198 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11199 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11200 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11201 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11202 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011203 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11204 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011205
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011206sub(<value>)
11207 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11208 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11209 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11210
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011211table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11212 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11213 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11214 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11215 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11216 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11217 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11218
11219
11220table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11221 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11222 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11223 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11224 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11225 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11226 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11227
11228table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11232 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11233 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11234
11235table_conn_cur(<table>)
11236 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11237 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11238 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11239 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11240 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11241
11242table_conn_rate(<table>)
11243 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11244 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11245 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11246 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11247 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11248
11249table_gpc0(<table>)
11250 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11251 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11252 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11253 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11254 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11255
11256table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11260 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11261 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11262 sample fetch keyword.
11263
11264table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11265 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11266 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11267 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11268 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11269 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11270
11271table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11272 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11273 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11274 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11275 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11276 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11277 keyword.
11278
11279table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11283 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11284 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11285
11286table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11289 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11290 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11291 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11292 keyword.
11293
11294table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11295 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11296 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11297 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11298 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11299 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11300 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11301 keyword.
11302
11303table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11304 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11305 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11306 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11307 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11308 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11309 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11310 keyword.
11311
11312table_server_id(<table>)
11313 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11314 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11315 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11316 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11317 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11318 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11319
11320table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11323 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11324 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11325 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11326 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11327 keyword.
11328
11329table_sess_rate(<table>)
11330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11332 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11333 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11334 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11335 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11336 keyword.
11337
11338table_trackers(<table>)
11339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11341 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11342 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11343 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11344 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11345 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11346 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11347 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11348 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11349
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011350upper
11351 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11352 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11353 type. The result is of type string.
11354
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011355url_dec
11356 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11357 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11358
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011359utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11360 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11361 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11362 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11363 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11364 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11365 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11366
11367 Example :
11368
11369 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11370 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11371 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11372
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011373word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11374 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11375 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11376
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011377wt6([<avalanche>])
11378 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11379 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11380 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11381 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11382 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11383 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11384 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011385 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11386 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011387
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011388xor(<value>)
11389 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11390 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11391
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011392
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113937.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394--------------------------------------------
11395
11396A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11397not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11398"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11399The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11400
11401always_false : boolean
11402 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11403 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11404
11405always_true : boolean
11406 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11407 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11408
11409avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011410 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011411 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11412 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11413 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11414 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11415 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11416 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11417 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11418 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11419 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11420 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11421 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11422 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11423 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011425be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011426 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11427 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11428 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11429 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11430 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11433 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11434 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11435 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11436 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11437 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11438 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011439
11440 Example :
11441 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11442 backend dynamic
11443 mode http
11444 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11445 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011447connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011449 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11451 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011452
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011453 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011454 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011455 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11456
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011457 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11458 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011459
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011460 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011461 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011462 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011463 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11464 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011466 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011467
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011468 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11469 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011470 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011471 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011472
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011473date([<offset>]) : integer
11474 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11475 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11476 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11477 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011478 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11479
11480 Example :
11481
11482 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11483 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011484
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011485env(<name>) : string
11486 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11487 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11488 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11489 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11490 certain way.
11491
11492 Examples :
11493 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11494 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11495
11496 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11497 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11500 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011501 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11502 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011503 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11504 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11505 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11506 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11507 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11510 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11511 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11512 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11513 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11514 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11515 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11516 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11517 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011518
11519 Example :
11520 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11521 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11522 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11523 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11524 frontend mail
11525 bind :25
11526 mode tcp
11527 maxconn 100
11528 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11529 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11530 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11531 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011532
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011533nbproc : integer
11534 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11535 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11536 and debugging purposes.
11537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11539 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11540 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11541 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011542 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11543 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11544 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011545
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011546proc : integer
11547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11548 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11549 debugging purposes.
11550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011551queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011552 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11553 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11554 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11556 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11557 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11558 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11559 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11560
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011561rand([<range>]) : integer
11562 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11563 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11564 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11565 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11566 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011568srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11569 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11570 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11571 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11572 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11573 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11574 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11575 methods.
11576
11577srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11578 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11579 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11580 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11581 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11582 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11583 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11584 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11585
11586srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11587 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11588 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011589 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11591 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11592 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11593 overloading servers).
11594
11595 Example :
11596 # Redirect to a separate back
11597 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11598 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11599 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11600
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011601stopping : boolean
11602 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11603 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11604 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011606table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11607 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11608 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11609
11610table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11611 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11612 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11613 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11614
11615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116167.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617----------------------------------
11618
11619The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11620closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11621methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11622sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11623TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011624the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11625counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11626"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011627argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11628the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11629this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011630
11631be_id : integer
11632 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11633 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11634
11635dst : ip
11636 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11637 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11638 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11639 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11640 RFC 4291.
11641
11642dst_conn : integer
11643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11644 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11645 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11646 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11647 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11648 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11649 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11650 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011652dst_port : integer
11653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11654 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11655 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11656 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11657 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11658 an HTTP header.
11659
11660fe_id : integer
11661 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11662 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11663 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11664
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011665sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011666sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11667sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11668sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011669 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11670 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11671 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011673sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011674sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11675sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11676sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011677 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11678 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11679 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11680
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011681sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011682sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11683sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11684sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011685 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11686 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011687 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11688 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11689 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011690
11691 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11692 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011693 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11694 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11695 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011696 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11697 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011699sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011700sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11701sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11702sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011703 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11704 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11705
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011706sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011707sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11708sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11709sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11711 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11712 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011714sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011715sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11716sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11717sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011718 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11719 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11720 See also src_conn_rate.
11721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011722sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011723sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11724sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11725sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011726 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011727 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011729sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011730sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11731sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11732sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011733 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11734 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11735 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011736 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11737 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11738 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011740sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011741sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11742sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11743sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011744 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11745 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11746 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011748sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011749sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11750sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11751sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011752 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11753 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11754 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11755 src_http_err_rate.
11756
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011757sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011758sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11759sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11760sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011761 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11762 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11763 src_http_req_cnt.
11764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011765sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011766sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11767sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11768sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011769 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11770 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11771 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11772 src_http_req_rate.
11773
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011774sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011775sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11776sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11777sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011778 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011779 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11780 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11781 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11782 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011783
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011784 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11785 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011786 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011788sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011789sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11790sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11791sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011792 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11793 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11794 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011796sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011797sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11798sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11799sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011800 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11801 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11802 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011804sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011805sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11806sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11807sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011808 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11809 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11810 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11811 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011812 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011813 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11814
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011815sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011816sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11817sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11818sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011819 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11820 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11821 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11822 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11823 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011824 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011826sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011827sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11828sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11829sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011830 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11831 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11832 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011834sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011835sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11836sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11837sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011838 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11839 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011840 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011841 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11842 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11844 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11845 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847so_id : integer
11848 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11849 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11850 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011852src : ip
11853 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11854 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11855 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11856 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11857 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11858 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11859 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011860
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011861 Example:
11862 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11863 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011865src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11866 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11867 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11868 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011869 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11872 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11873 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011874 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011875 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011877src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11878 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11879 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11880 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11881 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11882 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11883 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011884
11885 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11886 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11887 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11888 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011889 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011890 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11891 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011894 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011896 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011897 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011899src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011900 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011901 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11902 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011903 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011905src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11906 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11907 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11908 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011909 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011911src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011912 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011913 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011914 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011915 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011918 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011919 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011920 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11921 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011922 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11923 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11924 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011926src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11927 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11928 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011929 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011930 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011933src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11934 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11935 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11936 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11937 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011938 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011940src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11941 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11942 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11943 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011944 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11947 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11948 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11949 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011950 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011951 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011953src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11954 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11955 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11956 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011957 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11959 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011960
11961 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011962 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011963 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011965src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011966 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11967 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11968 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11969 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11970 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011972src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011973 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11974 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11975 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11976 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11977 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011979src_port : integer
11980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11981 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11982 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11983 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11986 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011987 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11988 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11989 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011990 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11993 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11994 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11995 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11996 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011997 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12000 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12002 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12003 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12004 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12005 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12006 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12007 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012008
12009 Example :
12010 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12011 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12012 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12013 listen ssh
12014 bind :22
12015 mode tcp
12016 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012017 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012018 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012019 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021srv_id : integer
12022 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12023 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12024 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012025
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012026
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120277.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012028----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012030The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12031closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12032when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12033usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012034future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012035
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012036ssl_bc : boolean
12037 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12038 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12039 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12040
12041ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12042 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12044
12045ssl_bc_cipher : string
12046 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12047 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12048
12049ssl_bc_protocol : string
12050 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12051 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12052
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012053ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012054 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012055 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12056 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012057
12058ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12059 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12060 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12061 if session was reused or not.
12062
12063ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12064 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12065 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012067ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12068 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12069 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12070 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12071 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12072 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012074ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12075 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12076 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12077 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12078 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012079
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012080ssl_c_der : binary
12081 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12082 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12083 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012085ssl_c_err : integer
12086 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12087 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12088 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12089 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12090 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012092ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12093 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12094 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12095 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12096 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12097 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12098 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12099 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12100 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012102ssl_c_key_alg : string
12103 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12104 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12105 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107ssl_c_notafter : string
12108 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12109 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12110 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012112ssl_c_notbefore : string
12113 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12114 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12115 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012117ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12118 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12119 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12120 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12121 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12122 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12123 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12124 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12125 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012127ssl_c_serial : binary
12128 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12129 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12130 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012132ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12133 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12134 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12135 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012136 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12137 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12138
12139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012141ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12142 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12143 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12144 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012146ssl_c_used : boolean
12147 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12148 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012150ssl_c_verify : integer
12151 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12152 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12153 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12154 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012156ssl_c_version : integer
12157 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12158 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012159
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012160ssl_f_der : binary
12161 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12162 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12163 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012165ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12166 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12167 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12168 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12169 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012170 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12172 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12173 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175ssl_f_key_alg : string
12176 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12177 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12178 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012180ssl_f_notafter : string
12181 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12182 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12183 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012185ssl_f_notbefore : string
12186 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12187 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12188 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012190ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12191 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12192 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12193 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12194 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12195 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12196 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12197 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12198 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200ssl_f_serial : binary
12201 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12203 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012204
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012205ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12206 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12207 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12208 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012210ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12211 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12212 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12213 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215ssl_f_version : integer
12216 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12217 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12218
12219ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012220 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12221 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12222 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012224 Example :
12225 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12226 listen http-https
12227 bind :80
12228 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12229 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12230
12231ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12232 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12233 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12234
12235ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012236 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12238 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12239 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12240 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12241 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12242 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12243 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12244 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012246ssl_fc_cipher : string
12247 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12248 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012250ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012251 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12252 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012253 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12254 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12255 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12256 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12259 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012260 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12261 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12262 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12263 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012264
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012265ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12266 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12267 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012269ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012270 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12272 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12273 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12274 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12275 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12276 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12277 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279ssl_fc_protocol : string
12280 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12281 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012282
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012283ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012284 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012285 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12286 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012288ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12289 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12290 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12291 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12292 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294ssl_fc_sni : string
12295 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12296 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12297 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12298 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12299 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12300
12301 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12302 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12303 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012304 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12305 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012307 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12309 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012311ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12312 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12313 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012314
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012317------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012319Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12320sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12321only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12322For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12323be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12324can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12325sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12326for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12327content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012329payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12330 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12331 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12332 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012334payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12335 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12336 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12337 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012339req.len : integer
12340req_len : integer (deprecated)
12341 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12342 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12343 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12344 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12345 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12346 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12347 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12348 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12351 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012352 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12353 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12354 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12355 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357 ACL alternatives :
12358 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12361 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12362 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12363 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12364 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012366 ACL alternatives :
12367 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012369 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012371req.proto_http : boolean
12372req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12373 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12374 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12375 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12376 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12377 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12378 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12379 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381 Example:
12382 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12383 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12384 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012385 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012387req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12388rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12389 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12390 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12391 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12392 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12393 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12394 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12395 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012397 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12398 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12399 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12400 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12401 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12402 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404 ACL derivatives :
12405 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407 Example :
12408 listen tse-farm
12409 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12410 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12411 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12412 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12413 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12414 persist rdp-cookie
12415 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12416 # This is only useful makes sense if
12417 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12418 stick-table type string size 204800
12419 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12420 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12421 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12424 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012426req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12427rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12428 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12429 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12430 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12431 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012433 ACL derivatives :
12434 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012436req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12437req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12438 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12439 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12440 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12441 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12442 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12443 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12444 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012446req.ssl_sni : string
12447req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12448 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12449 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12450 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12451 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12452 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12453 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12454 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12455 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12456 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12457 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12458 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12459 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461 ACL derivatives :
12462 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012464 Examples :
12465 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12466 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12467 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12468 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12469 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012471res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12472rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12473 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12474 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12475 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12476 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12477 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12478 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12479 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012481req.ssl_ver : integer
12482req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12483 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12484 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12485 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12486 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12487 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12488 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12489 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12490 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12491 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012493 ACL derivatives :
12494 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012495
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012496res.len : integer
12497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12498 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12499 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12500 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12501 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12502 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12503 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12504 content inspection.
12505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012506res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12507 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012508 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12509 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12510 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12511 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012513res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12514 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12515 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12516 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12517 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012521wait_end : boolean
12522 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12523 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12524 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12525 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12526 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12527 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12528 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12529 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012531 Examples :
12532 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12533 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12534 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012536 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12537 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12538 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12539 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12540 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12541 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12542 tcp-request content reject
12543
12544
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012546--------------------------------------
12547
12548It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12549This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12550data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12551its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12552HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12553content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12554to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12555more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12556response are indexed.
12557
12558base : string
12559 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12560 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12561 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12562 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12563 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12564 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12565 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12566 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12567
12568 ACL derivatives :
12569 base : exact string match
12570 base_beg : prefix match
12571 base_dir : subdir match
12572 base_dom : domain match
12573 base_end : suffix match
12574 base_len : length match
12575 base_reg : regex match
12576 base_sub : substring match
12577
12578base32 : integer
12579 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12580 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12581 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012582 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12583 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12584 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585
12586base32+src : binary
12587 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12588 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12589 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12590 per-URL counters.
12591
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012592capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12593 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12594 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12595 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12596
12597capture.req.method : string
12598 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12599 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12600 because it's allocated.
12601
12602capture.req.uri : string
12603 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12604 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12605 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12606 allocated.
12607
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012608capture.req.ver : string
12609 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12610 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12611 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12612
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012613capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12614 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12615 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12616 The first entry is an index of 0.
12617 See also: "capture response header"
12618
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012619capture.res.ver : string
12620 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12621 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12622 persistent flag.
12623
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012624req.body : binary
12625 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12626 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12627 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12628 the first chunk is analyzed.
12629
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012630req.body_param([<name>) : string
12631 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12632 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12633 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12634 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12635 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12636 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12637 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12638 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12639 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12640 given.
12641
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012642req.body_len : integer
12643 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12644 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12645 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12646 "option http-buffer-request".
12647
12648req.body_size : integer
12649 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12650 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12651 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12652 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12653 "option http-buffer-request".
12654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655req.cook([<name>]) : string
12656cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12657 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12658 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12659 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12660 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12661 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12662 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12663 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12664 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12665
12666 ACL derivatives :
12667 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12668 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12669 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12670 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12671 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12672 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12673 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12674 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12677cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12678 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12679 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012681req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12682cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12683 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12684 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12685 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12686 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012688cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12689 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12690 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12691 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12692 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12693 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12694 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12695 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12696 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12697 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12698 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12701 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12702 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12703 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12704 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012705 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012707req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12708 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12709 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12710 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12711 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12712 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12713 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12714 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12715 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12718 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12719 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12720 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12721 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12724 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12725 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12726 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12727 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12728 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12729 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12730 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12731 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12732 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12733 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12734 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 ACL derivatives :
12737 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12738 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12739 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12740 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12741 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12742 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12743 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12744 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12745
12746req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12747hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12748 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12749 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12750 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12751 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12752 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12753 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12754 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12755 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12756 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12757
12758req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12759hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12760 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12761 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12762 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12763 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12764 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12765 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12766 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12767 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12768
12769req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12770hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12771 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12772 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12773 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12774 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12775 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12776 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12777 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12778
12779http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12780 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12781 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12782 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12783 basic auth is supported.
12784
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012785http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12786 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12787 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12788 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12789 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12791 basic auth is supported.
12792
12793 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012794 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12795 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12796 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12797 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798
12799http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012800 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12801 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012802 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12803 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805method : integer + string
12806 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12807 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12808 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12809 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12810 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12811 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12812 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 ACL derivatives :
12815 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817 Example :
12818 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12819 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12820 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822path : string
12823 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12824 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12825 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12826 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12827 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12828 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12829 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 ACL derivatives :
12832 path : exact string match
12833 path_beg : prefix match
12834 path_dir : subdir match
12835 path_dom : domain match
12836 path_end : suffix match
12837 path_len : length match
12838 path_reg : regex match
12839 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012840
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012841query : string
12842 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12843 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12844 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12845 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12846 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12847 which stops before the question mark.
12848
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012849req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12850 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12851 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12852 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12853 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855req.ver : string
12856req_ver : string (deprecated)
12857 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12858 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12859 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861 ACL derivatives :
12862 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012864res.comp : boolean
12865 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12866 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12867 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869res.comp_algo : string
12870 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12871 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12872 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874res.cook([<name>]) : string
12875scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12876 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12877 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12878 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880 ACL derivatives :
12881 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12884scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12885 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12886 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12887 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12890scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12891 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12892 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12893 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12896 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12897 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12898 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12899 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12900 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12901 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12902 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12903 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12904 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12907 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12908 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12909 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12910 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12911 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012913res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12914shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12915 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12916 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12917 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12918 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12919 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12920 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12921 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12922 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 ACL derivatives :
12925 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12926 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12927 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12928 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12929 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12930 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12931 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12932 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12933
12934res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12935shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12936 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12937 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12938 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12939 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12940 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12943shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12944 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12945 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12946 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12947 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12948 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12949 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012950
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012951res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12952 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12953 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12954 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12955 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12958shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12959 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12960 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12961 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12962 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12963 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12964 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966res.ver : string
12967resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12968 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12969 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971 ACL derivatives :
12972 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12975 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12976 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12977 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12978 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12981 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012983 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985status : integer
12986 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12987 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12988 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990url : string
12991 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12992 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12993 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12994 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12995 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12996 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12997 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999 ACL derivatives :
13000 url : exact string match
13001 url_beg : prefix match
13002 url_dir : subdir match
13003 url_dom : domain match
13004 url_end : suffix match
13005 url_len : length match
13006 url_reg : regex match
13007 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009url_ip : ip
13010 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13011 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13012 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13013 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13014 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13015 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13016 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018url_port : integer
13019 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13020 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13021 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13022 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013023
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013024urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13025url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13027 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013028 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13029 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13030 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13031 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013032 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13033 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013034 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13035 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037 ACL derivatives :
13038 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13039 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13040 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13041 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13042 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13043 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13044 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13045 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013046
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048 Example :
13049 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13050 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13051 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13052 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013053
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013054urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013055 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13056 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13057 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013058
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130607.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013061---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013063Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13064every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013065order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013067ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13068---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013069FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013070HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013071HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13072HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013073HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13074HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13075HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13076HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13077LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013078METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13079METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13080METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13081METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13082METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13083METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013084RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013085REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013086TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013087WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13088---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013089
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130918. Logging
13092----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13095provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13096very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13097provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13098state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013099to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013100headers.
13101
13102In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13103about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13104send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13105
13106 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13107 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13108 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13109 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13110 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013111 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13112 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113
13114The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13115allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13116as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13117while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13118real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13119delay.
13120
13121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131228.1. Log levels
13123---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013124
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013125TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013126source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013127HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13128in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13129track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13130syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13131about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013132
13133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131348.2. Log formats
13135----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013136
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013137HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013138and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13139slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13140options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013141
13142 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13143 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13144 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13145 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13146 extents.
13147
13148 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13149 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13150 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13151 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13152 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13153
13154 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13155 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13156 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13157 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13158 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13159
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013160 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13161 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13162 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13163 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13164
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013165 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13166
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013167Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13168specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13169field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13170servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13171always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13172identifier.
13173
13174Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13175 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13176 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13177 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13178 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13179
13180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131818.2.1. Default log format
13182-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013183
13184This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13185as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13186format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13187
13188 Example :
13189 listen www
13190 mode http
13191 log global
13192 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13193
13194 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13195 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13196 (www/HTTP)
13197
13198 Field Format Extract from the example above
13199 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13200 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13201 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13202 4 'to' to
13203 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13204 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13205
13206Detailed fields description :
13207 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13208 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13209 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13210 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13211 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13212 and processed the connection.
13213 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13214
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013215In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13216"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13217connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13218
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013219It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13220will eventually disappear.
13221
13222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132238.2.2. TCP log format
13224---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013225
13226The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13227is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13228information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13229counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13230emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13231environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13232the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13233sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013234specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13235not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13236fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13237marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013238
13239 Example :
13240 frontend fnt
13241 mode tcp
13242 option tcplog
13243 log global
13244 default_backend bck
13245
13246 backend bck
13247 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13248
13249 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13250 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13251 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13252
13253 Field Format Extract from the example above
13254 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13255 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13256 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13257 4 frontend_name fnt
13258 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13259 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13260 7 bytes_read* 212
13261 8 termination_state --
13262 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13263 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13264
13265Detailed fields description :
13266 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013267 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13268 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13269 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13270 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13271 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013272
13273 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013274 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13275 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13276 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013277
13278 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13279 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13280 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13281 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13282
13283 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13284 and processed the connection.
13285
13286 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13287 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13288 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13289 applications.
13290
13291 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13292 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13293 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13294 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13295 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13296
13297 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13298 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13299 See "Timers" below for more details.
13300
13301 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13302 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13303 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13304 "Timers" below for more details.
13305
13306 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013307 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013308 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13309 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13310 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13311 details.
13312
13313 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13314 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13315 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13316 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13317 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13318
13319 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13320 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13321 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13322 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13323 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13324 for more details.
13325
13326 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013327 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013328 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13329 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13330 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013331 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013332
13333 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13334 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13335 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13336 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13337 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13338 caused by a denial of service attack.
13339
13340 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13341 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13342 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13343 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13344 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13345 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13346 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13347 denial of service attack.
13348
13349 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13350 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13351 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13352 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13353 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13354 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13355 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13356 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13357 be processed than on other servers.
13358
13359 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13360 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13361 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13362 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13363 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13364 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13365 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13366 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13367 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13368 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13369 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13370 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13371 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13372
13373 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13374 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13375 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13376 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13377 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13378 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13379 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13380 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13381
13382 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13383 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13384 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13385 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13386 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13387 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13388 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13389 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13390 occurs.
13391
13392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133938.2.3. HTTP log format
13394----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013395
13396The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13397is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13398the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13399are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13400emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13401generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13402"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13403which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013404frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13405is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013406
13407Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13408slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13409with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13410
13411 Example :
13412 frontend http-in
13413 mode http
13414 option httplog
13415 log global
13416 default_backend bck
13417
13418 backend static
13419 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13420
13421 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13422 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13423 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013424 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013425
13426 Field Format Extract from the example above
13427 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13428 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13429 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13430 4 frontend_name http-in
13431 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13432 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13433 7 status_code 200
13434 8 bytes_read* 2750
13435 9 captured_request_cookie -
13436 10 captured_response_cookie -
13437 11 termination_state ----
13438 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13439 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13440 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13441 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13442 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013444
13445Detailed fields description :
13446 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013447 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13448 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13449 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13450 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13451 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013452
13453 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013454 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13455 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13456 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013457
13458 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13459 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13460 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13461 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13462 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13463
13464 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13465 and processed the connection.
13466
13467 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13468 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13469 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13470
13471 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13472 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13473 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13474 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13475 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13476 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13477
13478 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13479 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13480 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13481 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13482 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13483 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13484
13485 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13486 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13487 See "Timers" below for more details.
13488
13489 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13490 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13491 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13492 below for more details.
13493
13494 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13495 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13496 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13497 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13498 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13499 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13500 for more details.
13501
13502 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013503 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013504 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13505 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13506 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13507 details.
13508
13509 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13510 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13511 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13512
13513 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13514 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13515 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13516 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13517 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13518 overflowing.
13519
13520 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13521 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13522 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13523 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13524 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13525 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13526 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13527 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13528
13529 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13530 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13531 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13532 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13533 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13534 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13535 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13536 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13537
13538 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13539 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13540 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13541 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13542 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13543 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13544 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13545
13546 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013547 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013548 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13549 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13550 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013551 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013552 system.
13553
13554 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13555 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13556 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13557 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13558 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13559 caused by a denial of service attack.
13560
13561 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13562 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13563 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13564 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13565 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13566 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13567 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13568 denial of service attack.
13569
13570 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13571 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13572 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13573 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13574 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13575 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13576 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13577 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13578 processed than on other servers.
13579
13580 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13581 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13582 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13583 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13584 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13585 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13586 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13587 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13588 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13589 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13590 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13591 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13592 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13593
13594 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13595 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13596 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13597 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13598 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13599 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13600 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13601 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13602
13603 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13604 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13605 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13606 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13607 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13608 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13609 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13610 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13611 occurs.
13612
13613 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13614 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13615 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13616 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13617 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13618 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13619 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13620 cookies" below for more details.
13621
13622 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13623 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13624 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13625 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13626 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13627 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13628 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13629 and cookies" below for more details.
13630
13631 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13632 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13633 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13634 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13635 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13636 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13637 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13638 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13639
13640
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200136418.2.4. Custom log format
13642------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013643
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013644The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013645mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013646
13647HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13648Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13649separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13650prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13651
13652Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13653variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13654string formats ("Q").
13655
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013656If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013657as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013658less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13659the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13660
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013661Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013662In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013663in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013664
13665Flags are :
13666 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013667 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013668
13669 Example:
13670
13671 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13672 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13673
13674At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13675
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013676 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13677 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013678
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013679the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013680
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013681 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013682 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013683 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013684
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013685and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13686
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013687 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013688 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13689
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013690Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13691
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013692 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013693 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013694 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13695 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13696 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013697 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13698 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13699 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013700 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013701 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13702 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13703 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13704 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013705 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013706 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013707 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013708 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013709 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013710 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13711 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013712 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013713 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13714 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013715 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013716 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13717 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013718 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13719 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13720 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013721 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013722 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13723 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013724 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013725 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13726 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13727 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013728 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013729 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013730 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13731 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13732 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13733 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013734 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013735 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013736 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013737 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013738 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013739 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013740 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13741 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13742 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013743 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013744 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13745 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013746 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013747 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013748 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013749 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013750
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013751 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013752
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013753
137548.2.5. Error log format
13755-----------------------
13756
13757When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13758protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13759By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13760"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13761will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13762logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13763
13764The format looks like this :
13765
13766 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13767 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13768 Connection error during SSL handshake
13769
13770 Field Format Extract from the example above
13771 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13772 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13773 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13774 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13775 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13776
13777These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13778failures.
13779
13780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137818.3. Advanced logging options
13782-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013783
13784Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13785just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13786options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13787for more information about their usage.
13788
13789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13791------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013792
13793It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13794haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13795commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13796monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13797ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13798
13799 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13800 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13801 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13802 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13803
13804 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13805 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13806 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013807 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013808 such as other load-balancers.
13809
13810 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13811 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13812 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13813
13814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13816----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013817
13818The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13819what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13820or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13821"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13822just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13823log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13824after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13825is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13826with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13827with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13828
13829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13831------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013832
13833Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13834for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13835"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13836retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13837raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13838a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13839file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13840you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13841"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13842
13843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13845--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013846
13847Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13848multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13849them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13850"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13851logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13852error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13853and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13854too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13855useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13856alternative.
13857
13858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138598.4. Timing events
13860------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013861
13862Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13863reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13864the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13865frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13866mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13867
13868 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13869 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13870 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13871 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13872 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13873
13874 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13875 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13876 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13877 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13878 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13879
13880 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13881 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13882 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13883 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13884 connection never established.
13885
13886 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13887 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13888 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13889 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13890 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13891 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13892 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13893 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13894 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13895 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13896 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13897
13898 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13899 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13900 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13901 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013902 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013903
13904 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13905
13906 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13907 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13908 negative.
13909
13910These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13911protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13912that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013913due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013914close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13915session has been aborted on timeout.
13916
13917Most common cases :
13918
13919 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13920 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13921 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13922 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13923 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13924 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13925 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13926 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13927 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013928 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13929 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13930 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013931
13932 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13933 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13934 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13935 of ms on remote networks.
13936
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013937 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13938 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13939 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013940
13941 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13942 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13943 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13944 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13945 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13946 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13947 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13948 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13949 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13950 to the server until another one is released.
13951
13952Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13953
13954 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13955 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13956 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13957
13958 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13959 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13960 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13961
13962 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13963 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13964 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13965 flags.
13966
13967 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13968 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13969 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13970 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13971 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13972 the client connection was maintained open.
13973
13974 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013975 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013976 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13977 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13978
13979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139808.5. Session state at disconnection
13981-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013982
13983TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13984"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
139852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13986each of which has a special meaning :
13987
13988 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13989 session to terminate :
13990
13991 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13992
13993 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13994 server explicitly refused it.
13995
13996 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13997 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13998 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13999 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014000 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14001
14002 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14003 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014004
14005 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14006 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14007 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14008 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14009 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14010
14011 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14012 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14013 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14014 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14015 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14016
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014017 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14018 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14019
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014020 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14021 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14022 backup connections when going up.
14023
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014024 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14025
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014026 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14027 send or receive data.
14028
14029 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14030 send or receive data.
14031
14032 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14033 with nothing left in the buffers.
14034
14035 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14036
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014037 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014038 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14039
14040 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14041 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14042 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14043 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14044 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14045
14046 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14047 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14048
14049 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14050 server (HTTP only).
14051
14052 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14053
14054 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14055 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14056 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14057
14058 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14059 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14060 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14061
14062 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14063
14064 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14065 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14066
14067 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14068 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14069 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14070
14071 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14072 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014073 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14074 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014075
14076 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14077 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14078 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14079 another server.
14080
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014081 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014082 server.
14083
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014084 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14085 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14086 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14087 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14088
14089 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14090 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14091 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14092 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14093
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014094 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14095 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14096 "use-server" rule).
14097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014098 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14099
14100 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14101 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14102
14103 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14104
14105 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14106 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14107 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14108
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014109 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14110 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014111 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014112 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14113 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14114
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014115 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14116
14117 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14118 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14119
14120 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14121
14122 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14123
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014124The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14125was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014126helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14127starvation, attacks, etc...
14128
14129The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14130alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14131easier finding and understanding.
14132
14133 Flags Reason
14134
14135 -- Normal termination.
14136
14137 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14138 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14139 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14140 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14141
14142 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14143 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14144 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14145 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14146 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14147 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014149 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14150 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014151 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014152
14153 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14154 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14155 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14156
14157 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14158 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14159 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14160 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14161 the server takes too long to respond.
14162
14163 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14164 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14165 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14166 long a time to respond.
14167
14168 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14169 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14170 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14171 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014172 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14173 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014174
14175 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14176 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14177 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14178 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14179 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014180 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014181 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14182 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14183 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14184 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14185 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14186 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14187 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14188 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14189 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14190 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14191 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14192 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014193
14194 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14195 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014196 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14197 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14198 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14199 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014200
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014201 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14202 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014204 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014205 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14206 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14207 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14208 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14209 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14210
14211 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14212 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14213 503 or 504 here.
14214
14215 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14216 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14217 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14218 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14219 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14220
14221 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14222 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014223 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014224 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14225 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14226
14227 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14228 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14229 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14230 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14231 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14232 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14233 between haproxy and the server.
14234
14235 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14236 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14237 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14238 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14239 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14240 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14241 solution is to fix the application.
14242
14243 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14244 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14245 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14246 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14247 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14248 external attacks.
14249
14250 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14251 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014252 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014253 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14254 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14255
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014256 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14257 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14258 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014259 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14260 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014262 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14263 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14264 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14265 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014266 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14267 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14268 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14269 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14270 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014271
14272 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14273 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14274 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14275 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14276
14277 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14278 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14279 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14280 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14281
14282 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14283 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14284 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14285 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14286
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014287The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14288persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14289important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14290re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14291
14292 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14293
14294 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14295 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14296 set on a GET request.
14297
14298 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14299 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014300 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014301 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14302
14303 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14304 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14305 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14306
14307 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14308 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14309 already got a cookie.
14310
14311 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14312 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14313 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14314 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14315 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14316
14317 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14318 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14319 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14320
14321 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14322 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14323 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14324
14325 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14326 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14327
14328 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14329 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14330 then advertised in the response.
14331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143338.6. Non-printable characters
14334-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014335
14336In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14337consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14338converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14339prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14340being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14341escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14342is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14343'}' when logging headers.
14344
14345Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14346issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14347containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14348
14349Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14350the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14351performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14352
14353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143548.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14355---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014356
14357Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14358achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014359section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014360cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14361the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14362the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014363locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014364not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14365user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14366a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14367wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14368
14369 Examples :
14370 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14371 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14372
14373 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14374 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14375
14376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143778.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14378---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014379
14380Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14381proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14382the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14383server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14384
14385Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14386response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014387section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014388
14389It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014390time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14391appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014392are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14393and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14394follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14395request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14396in the logs.
14397
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014398As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14399frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14400an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014402 Example :
14403 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14404 listen proxy-out
14405 mode http
14406 option httplog
14407 option logasap
14408 log global
14409 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14410
14411 # log the name of the virtual server
14412 capture request header Host len 20
14413
14414 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14415 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14416
14417 # log the beginning of the referrer
14418 capture request header Referer len 20
14419
14420 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14421 capture response header Server len 20
14422
14423 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14424 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14425
14426 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14427 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14428
14429 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14430 capture response header Via len 20
14431
14432 # log the URL location during a redirection
14433 capture response header Location len 20
14434
14435 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14436 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14437 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14438 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14439 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14440
14441 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14442 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14443 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14444 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014445 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014446
14447 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14448 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14449 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14450 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14451 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014452 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014453
14454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144558.9. Examples of logs
14456---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014457
14458These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14459them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14460reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14461
14462 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14463 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14464 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14465
14466 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14467 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14468
14469 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14470 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14471 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14472
14473 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14474 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14475
14476 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14477 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14478 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14479
14480 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014481 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014482 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14483 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14484
14485 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14486 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14487 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14488
14489 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14490 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014491 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014492 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14493 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14494 to return the 502 and not the server.
14495
14496 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014497 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014498
14499 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14500 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14501 Nothing was sent to any server.
14502
14503 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14504 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14505
14506 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14507 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14508 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14509 send a 408 return code to the client.
14510
14511 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14512 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14513
14514 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14515 5 seconds ("c----").
14516
14517 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14518 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014519 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014520
14521 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014522 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014523 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14524 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14525 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14526 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14527 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014528
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145309. Statistics and monitoring
14531----------------------------
14532
14533It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14534mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14535CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14536Unix socket.
14537
14538
145399.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014540---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014541
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014542The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014543page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14544begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14545represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14546use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14547('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14548(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14549text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14550do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14551use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014552
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014553In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14554that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14555S (Servers).
14556
14557 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14558 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14559 any name for server/listener)
14560 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14561 number queued without a server assigned.
14562 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14563 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14564 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14565 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14566 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14567 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14568 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14569 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14570 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14571 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14572 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14573 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14574 "option checkcache".
14575 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14576 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14577 - read error from the client
14578 - client timeout
14579 - client closed connection
14580 - various bad requests from the client.
14581 - request was tarpitted.
14582 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14583 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14584 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14585 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14586 active servers).
14587 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14588 Some other errors are:
14589 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14590 - failure applying filters to the response.
14591 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14592 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14593 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14594 switched away from.
14595 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014596 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14597 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14598 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014599 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14600 the server is up.)
14601 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14602 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14603 counters for each server.
14604 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14605 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14606 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14607 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14608 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14609 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14610 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14611 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14612 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14613 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14614 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14615 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14616 of times that server was selected.
14617 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14618 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14619 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14620 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14621 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14622 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014623 UNK -> unknown
14624 INI -> initializing
14625 SOCKERR -> socket error
14626 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014627 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014628 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14629 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14630 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14631 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14632 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14633 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14634 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14635 disable-on-404
14636 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14637 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14638 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014639 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14640 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14641 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14642 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14643 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14644 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14645 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14646 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14647 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14648 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14649 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14650 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14651 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14652 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14653 (inc. in eresp)
14654 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14655 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14656 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14657 (CPU/BW limit)
14658 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14659 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14660 server/backend
14661 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14662 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14663 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14664 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14665 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14666 (0 for TCP)
14667 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14668 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014669
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146719.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014672-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014673
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014674The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14675necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14676A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14677issuing commands by hand :
14678
14679 global
14680 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14681 stats timeout 2m
14682
14683It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14684the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14685never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14686situations :
14687
14688 global
14689 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14690 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14691 stats timeout 2m
14692
14693To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14694swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14695to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14696syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14697
14698 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14699 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14700
14701The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14702script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14703for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14704
14705The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14706that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14707editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14708(eg: watch a counter).
14709
14710The socket supports two operation modes :
14711 - interactive
14712 - non-interactive
14713
14714The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14715this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14716sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14717mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14718commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14719example :
14720
14721 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14722
14723The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14724entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14725for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14726sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14727"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14728after processing the last command of the same line.
14729
14730For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14731"prompt" command :
14732
14733 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14734 prompt
14735 > show info
14736 ...
14737 >
14738
14739Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14740delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14741that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14742parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014743
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014744It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14745on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14746own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014747
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014748The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14749If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14750all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14751it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14752
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014753add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014754 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14755 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14756 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14757 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014758
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014759add map <map> <key> <value>
14760 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14761 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014762 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14763 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14764 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014765
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014766clear counters
14767 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14768 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14769 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14770 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14771 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14772
14773clear counters all
14774 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14775 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14776 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14777
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014778clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014779 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14780 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14781 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014782
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014783clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014784 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14785 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14786 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014787
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014788clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14789 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14790
14791 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14792 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14793 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14794 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14795 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14796 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14797
14798 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14799
14800 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14801 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14802 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14803 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14804 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14805 the ACLs :
14806
14807 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14808 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14809 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14810 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14811 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14812 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14813
14814 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014815 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14816 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014817
14818 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014819 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014820 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014821 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14822 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14823 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14824 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014825
14826 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14827
14828 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014829 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014830 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14831 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014832 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14833 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14834 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014835
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014836del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14837 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014838 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14839 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14840 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14841 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014842
14843del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014844 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014845 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14846 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14847 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14848 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014849
14850disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014851 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14852
14853 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14854 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14855 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14856 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14857 re-enabled using enable agent.
14858
14859 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14860 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14861 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14862 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14863 otherwise unchanged.
14864
14865 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14866 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14867 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14868
14869 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14870 level "admin".
14871
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014872disable frontend <frontend>
14873 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14874 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14875 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14876 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14877 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14878 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14879 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14880 on the stats page.
14881
14882 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14883 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14884
14885 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14886 level "admin".
14887
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014888disable health <backend>/<server>
14889 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14890 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14891 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14892 agent check forces it down.
14893
14894 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14895 level "admin".
14896
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014897disable server <backend>/<server>
14898 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14899 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14900 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14901 during the maintenance.
14902
14903 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14904 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14905
14906 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014907 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014908
14909 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14910 level "admin".
14911
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014912enable agent <backend>/<server>
14913 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14914
14915 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14916 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14917
14918 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14919 level "admin".
14920
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014921enable frontend <frontend>
14922 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14923 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14924 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14925 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14926 which was disabled.
14927
14928 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14929 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14930
14931 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14932 level "admin".
14933
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014934enable health <backend>/<server>
14935 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14936 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14937
14938 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14939 level "admin".
14940
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014941enable server <backend>/<server>
14942 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14943 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14944
14945 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014946 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014947
14948 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14949 level "admin".
14950
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014951get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014952get acl <acl> <value>
14953 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14954 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14955 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14956 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14957 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014958
14959 The first two words are:
14960
14961 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14962 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14963 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14964
14965 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14966
14967 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14968
14969 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14970
14971 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14972 interpretation of the case.
14973
14974 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14975 useful with regular expressions.
14976
14977 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14978 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14979
14980 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14981 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14982 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14983
14984 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014986get weight <backend>/<server>
14987 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14988 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14989 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14990 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14991 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014992 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014993
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014994help
14995 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14996 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014997
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014998prompt
14999 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15000 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15001 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15002 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15003 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15004 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15005 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15006 command.
15007
15008quit
15009 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015010
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015011set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015012 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15013 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15014 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015015
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015016set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015017 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15018 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15019 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15020 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15021 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015022 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15023 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15024
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015025set maxconn global <maxconn>
15026 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15027 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15028 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15029 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15030 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15031 setting.
15032
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015033set rate-limit connections global <value>
15034 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15035 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15036 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15037 is passed in number of connections per second.
15038
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015039set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15040 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15041 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015042 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15043 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015044
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015045set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15046 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15047 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15048 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15049 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15050
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015051set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15052 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15053 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15054 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15055 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15056 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15057
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015058set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15059 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15060
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015061set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15062 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15063 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15064 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15065
15066set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15067 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15068 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15069 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15070
15071set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15072 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15073 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15074 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15075 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15076 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15077 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15078 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15079 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15080
15081set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15082 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15083 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15084
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015085set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15086 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15087 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15088 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15089 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15090
15091 Example:
15092 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15093 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15094 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15095 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15096
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015097set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15098 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15099 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15100 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15101 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15102 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15103
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015104set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015105 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15106 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15107 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15108 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015109 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15110 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015111
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015112set timeout cli <delay>
15113 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15114 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15115 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15116
15117set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15118 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15119 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015120 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15121 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15122 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15123 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15124 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15125 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15126 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15127 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15128 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15129 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15130 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15131 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15132 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015133
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015134show errors [<iid>]
15135 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15136 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015137 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15138 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15139 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015140
15141 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15142 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15143 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15144 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15145 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15146 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15147 are reported too.
15148
15149 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15150 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15151 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15152 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15153 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15154 code.
15155
15156 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15157 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15158 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15159 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15160 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15161 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15162 line.
15163
15164 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015165 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15166 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015167 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15168 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15169
15170 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15171 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15172 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15173 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15174 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15175 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15176 00204+ minal\r\n
15177 00211 \r\n
15178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015179 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015180 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15181 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15182 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15183 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15184 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15185 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015186
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015187show info
15188 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15189
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015190show map [<map>]
15191 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015192 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15193 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15194 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15195 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15196 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15197 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015198
15199show acl [<acl>]
15200 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015201 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15202 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15203 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15204 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15205 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015206
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015207show pools
15208 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15209 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15210 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15211 the pools.
15212
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015213show sess
15214 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015215 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15216 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15217
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015218show sess <id>
15219 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15220 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15221 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15222 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15223 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015224 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15225 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15226
15227 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15228 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015229
15230show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15231 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15232 possible to dump only selected items :
15233 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15234 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15235 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15236 for example:
15237 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15238 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15239 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15240
15241 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015242 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15243 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015244 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15245 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15246 Nbproc: 1
15247 Process_num: 1
15248 (...)
15249
15250 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15251 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15252 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15253 (...)
15254 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15255
15256 $
15257
15258 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15259 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15260 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15261 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015262 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015263
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015264show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15265 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15266 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15267 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15268 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15269 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15270 cname: number of CNAME responses
15271 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15272 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15273 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15274 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15275 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15276 other: any other DNS errors
15277 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15278 too_big: too big response
15279 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15280
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015281show table
15282 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15283 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15284 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15285 entries currently in use.
15286
15287 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015288 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015289 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15290 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015291
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015292show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015293 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15294 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15295 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015296 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15297
15298 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15299 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15300 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15301 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15302 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15303
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015304 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15305 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15306 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15307 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15308 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15309 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15310
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015311
15312 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015313 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15314 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015315
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015316 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015317 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015318 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015319 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15320 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15321 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15322 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015323
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015324 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015325 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015326 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15327 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015328
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015329 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15330 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015331 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015332 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15333 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015334
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015335 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15336 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015337 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015338 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15339 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15340
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015341 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15342 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15343 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15344 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15345 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15346
15347 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15348 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15349 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015350 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15351 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015352 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15353 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015354
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015355show tls-keys
15356 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15357 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15358 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15359
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015360shutdown frontend <frontend>
15361 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15362 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15363 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15364 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15365 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15366 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15367 once it is terminated.
15368
15369 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15370 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15371
15372 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15373 level "admin".
15374
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015375shutdown session <id>
15376 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15377 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15378 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15379 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15380 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15381 flag in the logs.
15382
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015383shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015384 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15385 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15386 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15387 'K' flag in the logs.
15388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015389/*
15390 * Local variables:
15391 * fill-column: 79
15392 * End:
15393 */